]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/gcc.git/blame - gcc/doc/tm.texi.in
re PR c++/50835 (Lvalue-ness of conditional operator results is incorrect in a functi...
[thirdparty/gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi.in
CommitLineData
38f8b050 1@c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001,
58cd1d70 2@c 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011
38f8b050
JR
3@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4@c This is part of the GCC manual.
5@c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
6
7@node Target Macros
8@chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
9@cindex machine description macros
10@cindex target description macros
11@cindex macros, target description
12@cindex @file{tm.h} macros
13
14In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
15includes a C header file conventionally given the name
16@file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
17The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
18about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
19@file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
20@file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
21@file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
22source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
23containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
24machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
25if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
26through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
27
28@menu
29* Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
30* Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
31* Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
32* Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
33* Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
34* Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
35* Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
36* Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
37* Old Constraints:: The old way to define machine-specific constraints.
38* Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
39* Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
40* Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
41* Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
42* Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
43* Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
44* Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
45* Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
46* Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
47* Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
48* PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
49* Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
50* Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
51* Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
52* Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
53* Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
54* Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
55* MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
56* PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
57* C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
58* Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
59* Misc:: Everything else.
60@end menu
61
62@node Target Structure
63@section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
64@cindex target hooks
65@cindex target functions
66
67@deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
68The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
69which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
70machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
71@file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
72used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
73for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
74macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
75@smallexample
76#include "target.h"
77#include "target-def.h"
78
79/* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
80
81#undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
82#define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
83
84struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
85@end smallexample
86@end deftypevar
87
88Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
89form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
90``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
91from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
92@code{targetm} structure.
93
acce4e77
JM
94Similarly, there is a @code{targetcm} variable for hooks that are
95specific to front ends for C-family languages, documented as ``C
96Target Hook''. This is declared in @file{c-family/c-target.h}, the
dd5a833e 97initializer @code{TARGETCM_INITIALIZER} in
acce4e77
JM
98@file{c-family/c-target-def.h}. If targets initialize @code{targetcm}
99themselves, they should set @code{target_has_targetcm=yes} in
100@file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default definition is used.
101
c49a6962
JM
102Similarly, there is a @code{targetm_common} variable for hooks that
103are shared between the compiler driver and the compilers proper,
104documented as ``Common Target Hook''. This is declared in
105@file{common/common-target.h}, the initializer
106@code{TARGETM_COMMON_INITIALIZER} in
107@file{common/common-target-def.h}. If targets initialize
108@code{targetm_common} themselves, they should set
109@code{target_has_targetm_common=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a
110default definition is used.
111
38f8b050
JR
112@node Driver
113@section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
114@cindex driver
115@cindex controlling the compilation driver
116
117@c prevent bad page break with this line
118You can control the compilation driver.
119
38f8b050
JR
120@defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
121A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
122initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
123
124The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
125default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
126choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
127applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
128options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
129using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
130
131This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
132options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
133that the other specs are easier to write.
134
135Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
136@end defmac
137
138@defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
139A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
140@option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
141for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
142outermost pair of surrounding braces.
143
144The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
145the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
146to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
147@samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
148everywhere it occurs.
149
150The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
151default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
152the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
153
154Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
155@end defmac
156
157@defmac CPP_SPEC
158A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
159pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
160give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
161
162Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
163@end defmac
164
165@defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
166This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
167than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
168@code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
169@end defmac
170
171@defmac CC1_SPEC
172A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
173pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
174front ends.
175It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
176for GCC to pass to front ends.
177
178Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
179@end defmac
180
181@defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
182A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
183pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
184give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
185
186Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
187Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
188@code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
189CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
190@end defmac
191
192@defmac ASM_SPEC
193A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
194pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
195you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
196See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
197
198Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
199@end defmac
200
201@defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
202A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
203run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
204Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
205an example of this.
206
207Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
208@end defmac
209
210@defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
211Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
212an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
213read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
214output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
215@option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
216
217If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
218standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
219cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
220see @file{mips.h} for instance.
221@end defmac
222
223@defmac LINK_SPEC
224A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
225pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
226give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
227
228Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
229@end defmac
230
231@defmac LIB_SPEC
232Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
233between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
234command given to the linker.
235
236If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
237loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
238@end defmac
239
240@defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
241Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
242how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
243linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
244the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
245
246If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
247passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
248@end defmac
249
250@defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
251By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
252@code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
253instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
254depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
255@option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
256targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
257@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
258driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
259line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
260@end defmac
261
262@defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
263A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
264mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
265generated that uses --as-needed and the shared libgcc in place of the
266static exception handler library, when linking without any of
267@code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
268@end defmac
269
270@defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
271If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
272When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
273the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
274@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
275@end defmac
276
277@defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
278Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
279difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
280the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
281
282If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
283standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
284@end defmac
285
286@defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
287Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
288difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
289the very end of the command given to the linker.
290
291Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
292@end defmac
293
294@defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
295GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
296However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
297models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
298@code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
299blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
300default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
301@code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
302@end defmac
303
304@defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
305Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
306configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
307et al, within sysroot+suffix.
308@end defmac
309
310@defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
311Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
312GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
313updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
314usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
315@end defmac
316
317@defmac EXTRA_SPECS
318Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
319@file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
320@code{CC1_SPEC}.
321
322The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
323containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
324string constant that provides the specification.
325
326Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
327
328@code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
329related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
330to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
331these definitions.
332
333For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
334define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
335used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
336used.
337
338The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
339
340@smallexample
341#define EXTRA_SPECS \
342 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
343
344#define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
345@end smallexample
346
347The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
348@smallexample
349#undef CPP_SPEC
350#define CPP_SPEC \
351"%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
352%@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
353%@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
354%@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
355
356#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
357#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
358@end smallexample
359
360while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
361@code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
362
363@smallexample
364#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
365#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
366@end smallexample
367@end defmac
368
369@defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
370Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
371@file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
372the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
373@end defmac
374
375@defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
376The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
377By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
378@end defmac
379
380@defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
381A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
382linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
383change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
384define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
385line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
386the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
387@code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
388@end defmac
389
390@defmac LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
391A nonzero value causes @command{collect2} to remove duplicate @option{-L@var{directory}} search
392directories from linking commands. Do not give it a nonzero value if
393removing duplicate search directories changes the linker's semantics.
394@end defmac
395
c49a6962
JM
396@hook TARGET_ALWAYS_STRIP_DOTDOT
397
38f8b050
JR
398@defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
399Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
400string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
401target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
402@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
403
404Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
405the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
406@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
407@xref{Target Fragment}.
408@end defmac
409
410@defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
411Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
412a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
413indicates an absolute file name.
414@end defmac
415
416@defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
417If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
418@code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
419when the compiler is built as a cross
420compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
421to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
422@end defmac
423
424@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
425Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
426standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
427try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
428@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
429is built as a cross compiler.
430@end defmac
431
432@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
433Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
434standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
435when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
436@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
437is built as a cross compiler.
438@end defmac
439
440@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
441Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
442standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
443default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
444@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
445is built as a cross compiler.
446@end defmac
447
448@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
449If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
450standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
451compiler is built as a cross compiler.
452@end defmac
453
454@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
455If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
456standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
457cross compiler.
458@end defmac
459
460@defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
461Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
462variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
463loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
464initialize the necessary environment variables.
465@end defmac
466
467@defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
468Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
469standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
470try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
08b2bad2
SB
471comes before @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR} (set in
472@file{config.gcc}, normally @file{/usr/include}) in the search order.
38f8b050
JR
473
474Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
475replacement.
476@end defmac
477
08b2bad2
SB
478@defmac NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_COMPONENT
479The ``component'' corresponding to @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}.
38f8b050
JR
480See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
481If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
482@end defmac
483
484@defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
485Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
486for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
487usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
08b2bad2
SB
488@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
489@code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
38f8b050
JR
490and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
491and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
492@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
493
494The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
495Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
496string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
497for C++-only directories,
498and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
499wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
500the array with a null element.
501
502The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
503if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
504or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
505operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
506
507For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
508
509@smallexample
510#define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
511@{ \
512 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
513 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
514 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
515 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
516 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
517@}
518@end smallexample
519@end defmac
520
521Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
522
523@enumerate
524@item
525Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
526
527@item
528The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
ff2ce160 529is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
38f8b050
JR
530@var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
531
532@item
533The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
534
535@item
536The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
ff2ce160 537in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
38f8b050
JR
538
539@item
ff2ce160 540The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
38f8b050
JR
541
542@item
ff2ce160 543The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
38f8b050
JR
544
545@item
ff2ce160 546The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
38f8b050
JR
547compiler.
548@end enumerate
549
550Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
551
552@enumerate
553@item
554Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
555
556@item
557The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
558value based on the installed toolchain location.
559
560@item
561The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
562(or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
563
564@item
565The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
ff2ce160 566in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
38f8b050
JR
567
568@item
569The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
570
571@item
ff2ce160 572The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
38f8b050
JR
573compiler.
574
575@item
ff2ce160 576The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
38f8b050
JR
577native compiler, or we have a target system root.
578
579@item
ff2ce160 580The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
38f8b050
JR
581native compiler, or we have a target system root.
582
583@item
584The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
585If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
586the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
587
588@item
589The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
590compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
591@file{/lib/}.
592
593@item
594The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
595compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
596@file{/usr/lib/}.
597@end enumerate
598
599@node Run-time Target
600@section Run-time Target Specification
601@cindex run-time target specification
602@cindex predefined macros
603@cindex target specifications
604
605@c prevent bad page break with this line
606Here are run-time target specifications.
607
608@defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
609This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
610built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
611the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
612@code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
613calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
614finished command line option processing your code can use those
615results freely.
616
617@code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
618command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
619the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
620accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
621
622@code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
623object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
624@code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
625defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
626with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
627only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
628example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
629and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
630@code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
631defines only @code{_ABI64}.
632
633You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
634@code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
635or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
636assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
637macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
638to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
639variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
640@code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
641preprocessing.
642@end defmac
643
644@defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
645Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
646and is used for the target operating system instead.
647@end defmac
648
649@defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
650Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
651and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
652macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
653it yourself.
654@end defmac
655
656@deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
657This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
658any target-specific headers.
659@end deftypevar
660
661@hook TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
662This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
663Its default setting is 0.
664@end deftypevr
665
666@cindex optional hardware or system features
667@cindex features, optional, in system conventions
668
669@hook TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION
670This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
671target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
672(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
673processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
674definition does nothing but return true.
675
96e45421
JM
676@var{decoded} specifies the option and its arguments. @var{opts} and
677@var{opts_set} are the @code{gcc_options} structures to be used for
678storing option state, and @var{loc} is the location at which the
679option was passed (@code{UNKNOWN_LOCATION} except for options passed
680via attributes).
38f8b050
JR
681@end deftypefn
682
683@hook TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION
684This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
685target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
686definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
687option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
688valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
689default definition does nothing but return false.
690
691In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
692options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
693only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
694should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
695@end deftypefn
696
91ebb981
IS
697@hook TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT
698
699@hook TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P
700
701@hook TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG
26705988 702
38f8b050
JR
703@hook TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE
704This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
705but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
706pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
707attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
708when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
709actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
710@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
711@end deftypefn
712
713@defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
c5387660
JM
714This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
715but is only used in the C
38f8b050
JR
716language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
717used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
718frontends.
719@end defmac
720
3020190e 721@hook TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
38f8b050 722Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
3020190e
JM
723various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
724options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
725options are processed once
38f8b050 726just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
3020190e 727of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
2b0d3573 728options passed explicitly.
38f8b050 729
3020190e 730This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
38f8b050
JR
731options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
732@code{optimize} attribute.
3020190e 733@end deftypevr
38f8b050 734
7e4aae92
JM
735@hook TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT
736
128dc8e2
JM
737@hook TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS
738
3bd36029
RS
739@defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
740Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
741during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
742the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
743can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
744and @code{nomips16} attributes.
745
746Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
747registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
748operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
749in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
750significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
751for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
752switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
753
754Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
755is 0.
756@end defmac
757
38f8b050
JR
758@node Per-Function Data
759@section Defining data structures for per-function information.
760@cindex per-function data
761@cindex data structures
762
763If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
764provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
765using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
766nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
767when another one comes along.
768
769GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
770contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
771structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
772@code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
773to their own specific data.
774
775If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
776@code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
777This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
778@code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
779
780One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
781RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
782RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
783function, for level 0.
784
785Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
786all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
787function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
788stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
789stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
790@code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
791the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
792single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
793longer supported.
794
795@defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
796Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
797is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
798The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
799function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
800@end defmac
801
802@deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
803If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
804function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
805target to perform any target specific initialization of the
806@code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
807used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
808
809@code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
810Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
811GC allocation, including the structure itself.
812@end deftypevar
813
814@node Storage Layout
815@section Storage Layout
816@cindex storage layout
817
818Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
819alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
820expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
821@xref{Run-time Target}.
822
823@defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
824Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
825byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
826This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
827bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
828be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
829macro need not be a constant.
830
831This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
832bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
833@end defmac
834
835@defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
836Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
837word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
838@end defmac
839
840@defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
841Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
842most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
c0a6a1ef
BS
843memory locations and registers; see @code{REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} if the
844order of words in memory is not the same as the order in registers. This
38f8b050
JR
845macro need not be a constant.
846@end defmac
847
c0a6a1ef
BS
848@defmac REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
849On some machines, the order of words in a multiword object differs between
850registers in memory. In such a situation, define this macro to describe
851the order of words in a register. The macro @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} controls
852the order of words in memory.
853@end defmac
854
38f8b050
JR
855@defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
856Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
857@code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
858containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
859have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
860
861You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
862multi-word integers.
863@end defmac
864
865@defmac BITS_PER_UNIT
866Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
867unit (byte). If you do not define this macro the default is 8.
868@end defmac
869
870@defmac BITS_PER_WORD
871Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
872is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
873@end defmac
874
875@defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
876Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
877@code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
878largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
879@end defmac
880
881@defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
882Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
883register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
884@end defmac
885
886@defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
887Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
888@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
889smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
890@end defmac
891
38f8b050
JR
892@defmac POINTER_SIZE
893Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
894width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
895you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
896a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
897@end defmac
898
899@defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
900A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
901@code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
902greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
903should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
904is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
905@code{ptr_extend} instruction.
906
907You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
908and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
909@end defmac
910
911@defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
912A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
913is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
914stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
915scalar type.
916
917On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
918register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
919@var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
920cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
921floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
922counterparts.
923
924For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
925However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
926either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
927the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
928sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
929@var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
930
931Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
932@end defmac
933
934@hook TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE
935Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
936function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
937and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
938change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
939pointer} types.
940
941@var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
942return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
943@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
944If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
945which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
946then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
947the signedness may be different.
948
5e617be8
AK
949@var{type} can be NULL when promoting function arguments of libcalls.
950
38f8b050
JR
951The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
952also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
953if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
954@end deftypefn
955
956@defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
957Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
958bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
959regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
960size of an integer.
961@end defmac
962
963@defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
964Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
965stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
966desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
967if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
968this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
969@end defmac
970
971@defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
972Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
973stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
974is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
975macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
976@code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
977@end defmac
978
979@defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
980Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
981from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
982to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
983@end defmac
984
985@defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
986Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
987@end defmac
988
989@defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
990Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
991bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
992just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
993@end defmac
994
995@defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
996Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
997provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
998@end defmac
999
1000@defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1001Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1002not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1003@end defmac
1004
1005@defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1006If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1007object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1008nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1009on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1010@end defmac
1011
1012@defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1013Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1014machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1015structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1016by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1017@end defmac
1018
1019@defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1020An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1021alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1022@code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1023alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1024field alignment has not been set by the
1025@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1026@end defmac
1027
1028@defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1029Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1030to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1031
1032If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1033
1034@c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1035@c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1036@c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1037@c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1038@end defmac
1039
1040@defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1041Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1042Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1043@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1044the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1045
1046On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1047the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1048a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((unsigned HOST_WIDEST_INT) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1049On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1050@samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1051@end defmac
1052
1053@defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1054If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1055the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1056the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1057macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1058
1059If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1060
1061@findex strcpy
1062One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1063make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1064arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1065constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1066@end defmac
1067
1068@defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1069If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1070that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1071@var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1072have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1073align the object.
1074
1075If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1076
1077The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1078constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1079constants can be done inline.
1080@end defmac
1081
1082@defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1083If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1084the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1085the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1086macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1087
1088If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1089
1090One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1091make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
4a6336ad 1092
64ad7c99 1093If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
38f8b050
JR
1094@end defmac
1095
1096@defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1097If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1098@var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1099and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1100have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1101align the slot.
1102
1103If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1104@var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1105be used.
1106
1107This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1108of all possible modes which the slot may have.
4a6336ad 1109
64ad7c99 1110If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
38f8b050
JR
1111@end defmac
1112
1113@defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1114If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1115variable @var{decl}.
1116
1117If this macro is not defined, then
1118@code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1119is used.
1120
1121One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1122make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
4a6336ad 1123
64ad7c99 1124If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
38f8b050
JR
1125@end defmac
1126
1127@defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1128If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1129for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1130@var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1131
1132If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1133@end defmac
1134
1135@defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1136Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1137empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1138
1139If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1140@end defmac
1141
1142@defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1143Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1144Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1145
1146If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1147@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1148@end defmac
1149
1150@defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1151Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1152if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1153go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1154@end defmac
1155
1156@defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1157Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1158alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1159
1160The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1161@code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1162structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1163that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1164that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1165
1166Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1167@code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1168four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1169not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1170
1171An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1172structure.
1173
1174If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1175a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1176
1177Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1178bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1179support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1180@samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1181
1182The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1183@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1184Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1185
1186Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1187@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1188@code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1189
1190If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1191bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1192what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1193
1194@smallexample
1195struct foo1
1196@{
1197 char x;
1198 char :0;
1199 char y;
1200@};
1201
1202struct foo2
1203@{
1204 char x;
1205 int :0;
1206 char y;
1207@};
1208
1209main ()
1210@{
1211 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1212 sizeof (struct foo1));
1213 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1214 sizeof (struct foo2));
1215 exit (0);
1216@}
1217@end smallexample
1218
1219If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1220get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1221@end defmac
1222
1223@defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1224Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1225to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1226@end defmac
1227
1228@hook TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD
1229When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1230whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1231structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1232the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1233@end deftypefn
1234
1235@hook TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD
1236This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1237should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1238these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1239
1240The default is @code{!TARGET_STRICT_ALIGN}.
1241@end deftypefn
1242
1243@defmac MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (@var{field}, @var{mode})
1244Return 1 if a structure or array containing @var{field} should be accessed using
1245@code{BLKMODE}.
1246
1247If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1248mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1249case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1250retain the field's mode.
1251
1252Normally, this is not needed.
1253@end defmac
1254
1255@defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1256Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1257by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1258way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1259@var{specified}.
1260
1261The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1262the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1263@end defmac
1264
1265@defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1266An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1267machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1268this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1269appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1270(DImode)} is assumed.
1271@end defmac
1272
1273@defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1274If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1275specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1276@code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1277@var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1278@code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1279having its mode specified.
1280
1281You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1282would most commonly define this macro if the
1283@code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
128464-bit mode.
1285@end defmac
1286
1287@defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1288If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1289specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1290@code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1291
1292You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1293You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1294pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1295@end defmac
1296
1297@hook TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE
1298This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1299of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1300@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1301targets.
1302@end deftypefn
1303
1304@hook TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE
1305This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1306of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1307@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1308targets.
1309@end deftypefn
1310
1311@hook TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE
1312Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1313The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1314@end deftypefn
1315
1316@defmac ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
1317If defined, this macro should be true if the prevailing rounding
1318mode is towards zero.
1319
1320Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1321floating-point arithmetic.
1322
1323Not defining this macro is equivalent to returning zero.
1324@end defmac
1325
1326@defmac LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL (@var{size})
1327This macro should return true if floats with @var{size}
1328bits do not have a NaN or infinity representation, but use the largest
1329exponent for normal numbers instead.
1330
1331Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1332floating-point arithmetic.
1333
1334The default definition of this macro returns false for all sizes.
1335@end defmac
1336
1337@hook TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P
1338This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1339@var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1340Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1341unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1342different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1343alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1344bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1345the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1346(iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1347another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1348other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1349
1350When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1351of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1352bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1353and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1354chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1355size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1356alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1357
1358If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1359the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1360used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1361precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1362may affect its placement.
1363@end deftypefn
1364
1365@hook TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P
1366Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1367@end deftypefn
1368
1369@hook TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P
1370Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1371@end deftypefn
1372
1373@hook TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK
1374This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1375to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1376For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1377for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1378registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1379usage.
1380@end deftypefn
1381
1382@hook TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS
1383This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1384that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1385@end deftypefn
1386
1387@hook TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE
1388If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1389uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1390to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1391mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1392the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1393not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1394for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1395return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1396string constant.
1397
1398Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1399qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1400fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1401is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1402length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1403ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1404@var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1405@var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1406code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1407@code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1408codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1409spaces in your string.
1410
1411This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1412name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1413can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1414before mangling.
1415
1416The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1417appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1418types.
1419@end deftypefn
1420
1421@node Type Layout
1422@section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1423
1424These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1425basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1426the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1427languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1428
1429@defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1430A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1431target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1432@end defmac
1433
1434@defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1435A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1436target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1437(If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1438unit.)
1439@end defmac
1440
1441@defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1442A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1443target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1444@end defmac
1445
1446@defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1447On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1448@code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1449that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1450the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1451value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1452@end defmac
1453
1454@defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1455A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1456target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1457words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1458macro must be at least 64.
1459@end defmac
1460
1461@defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1462A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1463target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1464@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1465@end defmac
1466
1467@defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1468A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1469C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1470this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1471@end defmac
1472
1473@defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1474A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1475target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1476@end defmac
1477
1478@defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1479A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1480target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1481words.
1482@end defmac
1483
1484@defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1485A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1486the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1487words.
1488@end defmac
1489
1490@defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1491A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1492the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1493@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1494@end defmac
1495
1496@defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1497A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1498the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1499@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1500@end defmac
1501
1502@defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1503A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1504the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1505@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1506@end defmac
1507
1508@defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1509A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1510the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1511@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1512@end defmac
1513
1514@defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1515A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1516the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1517@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1518@end defmac
1519
1520@defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1521A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1522the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1523@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1524@end defmac
1525
1526@defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1527A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1528the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1529@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1530@end defmac
1531
1532@defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1533A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1534the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1535@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1536@end defmac
1537
1538@defmac LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1539Define this macro if @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not constant or
1540if you want routines in @file{libgcc2.a} for a size other than
1541@code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}. If you don't define this, the
1542default is @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1543@end defmac
1544
1545@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_DF_MODE
a18bdccd 1546Define this macro if neither @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} nor
38f8b050
JR
1547@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is
1548@code{DFmode} but you want @code{DFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
a18bdccd 1549anyway. If you don't define this and either @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
38f8b050
JR
1550or @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64 then the default is 1,
1551otherwise it is 0.
1552@end defmac
1553
1554@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_XF_MODE
1555Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1556@code{XFmode} but you want @code{XFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1557anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1558is 80 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1559@end defmac
1560
1561@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_TF_MODE
1562Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1563@code{TFmode} but you want @code{TFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1564anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1565is 128 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1566@end defmac
1567
cdbf4541
BS
1568@defmac LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX
1569This macro corresponds to the @code{TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX} target
1570hook and should be defined if that hook is overriden to be true. It
1571causes function names in libgcc to be changed to use a @code{__gnu_}
1572prefix for their name rather than the default @code{__}. A port which
1573uses this macro should also arrange to use @file{t-gnu-prefix} in
1574the libgcc @file{config.host}.
1575@end defmac
1576
38f8b050
JR
1577@defmac SF_SIZE
1578@defmacx DF_SIZE
1579@defmacx XF_SIZE
1580@defmacx TF_SIZE
1581Define these macros to be the size in bits of the mantissa of
1582@code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} values,
1583if the defaults in @file{libgcc2.h} are inappropriate. By default,
1584@code{FLT_MANT_DIG} is used for @code{SF_SIZE}, @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG}
1585for @code{XF_SIZE} and @code{TF_SIZE}, and @code{DBL_MANT_DIG} or
1586@code{LDBL_MANT_DIG} for @code{DF_SIZE} according to whether
a18bdccd 1587@code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} or
38f8b050
JR
1588@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64.
1589@end defmac
1590
1591@defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1592A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1593assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1594default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1595@code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1596@end defmac
1597
1598@defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1599A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1600supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1601value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1602If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1603is the default.
1604@end defmac
1605
1606@defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1607An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1608@code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1609always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1610and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1611@end defmac
1612
1613@hook TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
1614This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1615@code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1616of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
1617@code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1618
1619The default is to return false.
1620@end deftypefn
1621
1622@defmac SIZE_TYPE
1623A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1624for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1625contents of the string.
1626
1627The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1628spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1629appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1630of the data type names defined in the function
1631@code{init_decl_processing} in the file @file{c-decl.c}. You may not
1632omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the compiler to
1633crash on startup.
1634
1635If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1636int"}.
1637@end defmac
1638
1639@defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1640A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1641for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1642@code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1643@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1644
1645If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1646@end defmac
1647
1648@defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1649A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1650for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1651the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1652information.
1653
1654If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1655@end defmac
1656
1657@defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1658A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1659characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1660@code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1661@end defmac
1662
1663@defmac WINT_TYPE
1664A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1665use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1666@code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1667contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1668information.
1669
1670If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1671@end defmac
1672
1673@defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1674A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1675can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1676The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1677string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1678
1679If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1680@code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1681much precision as @code{long long int}.
1682@end defmac
1683
1684@defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1685A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1686can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1687type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1688of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1689
1690If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1691@code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1692unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1693int}.
1694@end defmac
1695
1696@defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1697@defmacx INT8_TYPE
1698@defmacx INT16_TYPE
1699@defmacx INT32_TYPE
1700@defmacx INT64_TYPE
1701@defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1702@defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1703@defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1704@defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1705@defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1706@defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1707@defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1708@defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1709@defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1710@defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1711@defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1712@defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1713@defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1714@defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1715@defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1716@defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1717@defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1718@defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1719@defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1720@defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1721@defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1722@defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1723C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1724@code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1725@code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1726@code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1727@code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1728@code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1729@code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1730@code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1731@code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1732@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1733
1734If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1735type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1736@code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1737to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1738these macros are null pointers.
1739@end defmac
1740
1741@defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1742The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1743that looks like:
1744
1745@smallexample
1746 struct @{
1747 union @{
1748 void (*fn)();
1749 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1750 @};
1751 ptrdiff_t delta;
1752 @};
1753@end smallexample
1754
1755@noindent
1756The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1757will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1758Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1759always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1760distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1761platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1762that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1763the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1764
1765GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1766this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1767However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1768set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1769bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1770address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1771architecture, you should define this macro to
1772@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1773
1774In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1775in which function addresses are always even, according to
1776@code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1777@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1778@end defmac
1779
1780@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1781Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1782macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1783instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1784function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1785data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1786pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1787
1788If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1789of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1790@end defmac
1791
1792@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1793By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1794is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1795the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1796when special alignment is necessary. */
1797@end defmac
1798
1799@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1800There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1801zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1802specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1803of words in each data entry.
1804@end defmac
1805
1806@node Registers
1807@section Register Usage
1808@cindex register usage
1809
1810This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1811has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1812
1813The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1814done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1815on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1816For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1817For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1818
1819@menu
1820* Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1821* Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1822* Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1823* Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1824* Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1825@end menu
1826
1827@node Register Basics
1828@subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1829
1830@c prevent bad page break with this line
1831Registers have various characteristics.
1832
1833@defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1834Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1835numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1836pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1837@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1838@end defmac
1839
1840@defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1841@cindex fixed register
1842An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1843all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1844general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1845pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1846register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1847machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1848and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1849
1850This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1851commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1852register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1853
1854The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1855the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1856by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1857the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1858@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1859@end defmac
1860
1861@defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1862@cindex call-used register
1863@cindex call-clobbered register
1864@cindex call-saved register
1865Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1866clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1867registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1868available for general allocation of values that must live across
1869function calls.
1870
1871If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1872automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1873exit, if the register is used within the function.
1874@end defmac
1875
1876@defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1877@cindex call-used register
1878@cindex call-clobbered register
1879@cindex call-saved register
1880Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1881that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1882(@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1883This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1884of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1885@end defmac
1886
1887@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1888@cindex call-used register
1889@cindex call-clobbered register
1890@cindex call-saved register
1891A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1892value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1893call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1894macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1895preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1896@end defmac
1897
1898@findex fixed_regs
1899@findex call_used_regs
1900@findex global_regs
1901@findex reg_names
1902@findex reg_class_contents
5efd84c5
NF
1903@hook TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
1904This hook may conditionally modify five variables
38f8b050
JR
1905@code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1906@code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1907any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1908of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1909@code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1910@code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1911called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1912@code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1913from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1914@code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1915@code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1916@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1917command options have been applied.
1918
38f8b050
JR
1919@cindex disabling certain registers
1920@cindex controlling register usage
1921If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1922flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1923@code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1924registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also define
1925the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} / @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
1926to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
1927is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
1928
1929(However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1930of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1931controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1932these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
5efd84c5 1933@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
1934
1935@defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1936Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1937expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1938corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1939function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1940outbound register.
1941@end defmac
1942
1943@defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1944Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1945expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1946corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1947function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1948register.
1949@end defmac
1950
1951@defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1952Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1953expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1954register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1955need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1956gotos.
1957@end defmac
1958
1959@defmac PC_REGNUM
1960If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1961register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
1962@end defmac
1963
1964@node Allocation Order
1965@subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1966@cindex order of register allocation
1967@cindex register allocation order
1968
1969@c prevent bad page break with this line
1970Registers are allocated in order.
1971
1972@defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1973If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
1974numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
1975to use them (from most preferred to least).
1976
1977If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1978(all else being equal).
1979
1980One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1981registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1982instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
1983machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
1984the highest numbered allocable register first.
1985@end defmac
1986
1987@defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1988A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
1989hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
1990
1991Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
1992Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
1993register; and so on.
1994
1995The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
1996@code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
1997
1998On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
1999@end defmac
2000
2001@defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2002Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
2003prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
2004using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
2005allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
2006call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, this macro
2007should be defined.
2008@end defmac
2009
2010@defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
2011In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
2012Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
2013If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
2014based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2015be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2016value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2017to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2018
2019On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2020@end defmac
2021
2022@node Values in Registers
2023@subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2024
2025This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2026(specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2027consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2028
2029@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2030A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2031at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2032@var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2033cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2034and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
2035
2036On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2037definition of this macro is
2038
2039@smallexample
2040#define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2041 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
2042 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2043@end smallexample
2044@end defmac
2045
2046@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2047A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2048in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2049in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2050multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2051this mode by the number of registers returned by
2052@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2053
2054For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2055registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2056nonzero.
2057
2058This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2059@code{subreg_get_info}
2060would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2061represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2062@code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2063registers and so not be representable.
2064@end defmac
2065
2066@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2067For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2068@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2069returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2070including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2071@end defmac
2072
2073@defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2074Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2075of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2076should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2077used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2078happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2079floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2080@end defmac
2081
2082@defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2083A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2084of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2085registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2086are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2087
2088@smallexample
2089#define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2090@end smallexample
2091
2092You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2093because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2094
2095@cindex register pairs
2096On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2097register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2098odd register numbers for such modes.
2099
2100The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2101@samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2102register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2103value into the register and back out not alter it.
2104
2105Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2106all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2107@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2108you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2109is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2110and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2111to be tieable.
2112
2113Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2114Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2115in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2116can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2117mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2118registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2119
2120On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2121modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2122registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2123non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2124@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2125floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2126normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2127unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2128register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2129
2130The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2131they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2132instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2133@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2134constraints for those instructions.
2135
2136On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2137so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2138register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2139floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2140be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2141@end defmac
2142
2143@defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2144A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2145@var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2146
2147One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2148another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2149handler.
2150
2151The default is always nonzero.
2152@end defmac
2153
2154@defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2155A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2156@var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2157
2158If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2159@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2160any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2161should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2162this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2163accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2164
2165You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2166possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2167allocation.
2168@end defmac
2169
2170@hook TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK
2171This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2172@var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2173
2174One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2175is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2176
2177The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2178@end deftypefn
2179
2180@defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2181Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2182registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2183@code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2184@end defmac
2185
2186@node Leaf Functions
2187@subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2188
2189@cindex leaf functions
2190@cindex functions, leaf
2191On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2192more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2193means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2194are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2195normally arrive.
2196
2197The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2198other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2199registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2200function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2201handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2202functions''.
2203
2204GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2205suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2206registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2207accomplish this.
2208
2209@defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2210Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2211contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2212function treatment.
2213
2214If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2215registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2216GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2217used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2218in this vector.
2219
2220Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2221the treatment of leaf functions.
2222@end defmac
2223
2224@defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2225A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2226should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2227
2228If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2229function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2230will cause the compiler to abort.
2231
2232Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2233treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2234this.
2235@end defmac
2236
2237@findex current_function_is_leaf
2238@findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2239@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2240@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2241specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2242which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2243set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2244compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2245@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2246functions which only use leaf registers.
2247@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2248that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2249@code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2250@c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2251@c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2252
2253@node Stack Registers
2254@subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2255
2256There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2257``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2258pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2259stack.
2260
2261Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2262they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2263support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2264point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2265stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2266@file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2267with it, as well as defining these macros.
2268
2269@defmac STACK_REGS
2270Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2271@end defmac
2272
2273@defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2274This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2275the machine has any stack-like registers.
2276@end defmac
2277
2278@defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2279The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2280of the stack.
2281@end defmac
2282
2283@defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2284The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2285the stack.
2286@end defmac
2287
2288@node Register Classes
2289@section Register Classes
2290@cindex register class definitions
2291@cindex class definitions, register
2292
2293On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2294For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2295certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2296restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2297
2298You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2299which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2300that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2301
2302@findex ALL_REGS
2303@findex NO_REGS
2304In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2305class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2306class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2307union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2308
2309@findex GENERAL_REGS
2310One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2311terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2312@samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2313the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2314to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2315
2316Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2317then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2318
2319The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2320constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2321You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2322them in operand constraints.
2323
6049a4c8
HPN
2324You must define the narrowest register classes for allocatable
2325registers, so that each class either has no subclasses, or that for
2326some mode, the move cost between registers within the class is
2327cheaper than moving a register in the class to or from memory
2328(@pxref{Costs}).
2329
38f8b050
JR
2330You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2331instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2332either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2333certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
b899fd78
JR
2334which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code,
2335or even internal compiler errors when reload cannot find a register in the
dd5a833e 2336class computed via @code{reg_class_subunion}.
38f8b050
JR
2337
2338You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2339classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2340contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2341in their union.
2342
2343When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2344certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2345Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2346a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2347specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2348
2349Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2350instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2351each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2352mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2353single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2354this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2355instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2356single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2357@code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2358
2359@deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2360An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2361as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2362must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2363@code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2364tells how many classes there are.
2365
2366Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2367the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2368in many of the tables described below.
2369@end deftp
2370
2371@defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2372The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2373
2374@smallexample
2375#define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2376@end smallexample
2377@end defmac
2378
2379@defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2380An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2381constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2382@end defmac
2383
2384@defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2385An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2386which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2387@var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2388register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2389
2390When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2391Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2392several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2393for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2394In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2395registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2396so on.
2397@end defmac
2398
2399@defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2400A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2401@var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2402which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2403register.
2404@end defmac
2405
2406@defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2407A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2408base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2409which is the register value plus a displacement.
2410@end defmac
2411
2412@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2413This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2414the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2415@var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2416@code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2417@end defmac
2418
2419@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2420A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2421base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2422register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2423addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2424@end defmac
2425
2426@defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2427A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2428base register must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code} define the
2429context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is the code of
2430the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level of an
2431address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2432@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2433index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2434@end defmac
2435
2436@defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2437A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2438index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2439address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2440added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2441@end defmac
2442
2443@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2444A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2445suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
38f8b050
JR
2446@end defmac
2447
2448@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2449A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2450that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2451@var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2452reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2453you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2454@code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2455addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2456@code{address_operand}.
38f8b050
JR
2457@end defmac
2458
2459@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2460A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2461use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2462memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2463pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2464define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2465than other base register uses.
2466
2467Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2468@code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
38f8b050
JR
2469@end defmac
2470
2471@defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2472A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2473that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2474appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2475immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2476address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2477@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2478corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2479@code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2480that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
38f8b050
JR
2481@end defmac
2482
2483@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2484A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2485suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2486either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2487allocated such a hard register.
2488
2489The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2490the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2491two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2492labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2493labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2494may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2495looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2496only if neither labeling works.
38f8b050
JR
2497@end defmac
2498
5f286f4a
YQ
2499@hook TARGET_PREFERRED_RENAME_CLASS
2500
fba42e24
AS
2501@hook TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS
2502A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2503to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2504@var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2505another, smaller class.
2506
2507The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2508
2509Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2510example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2511for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2512@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2513Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2514
2515One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2516@var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2517loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2518force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2519immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2520instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2521register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2522@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2523into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
1a627b35 2524@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
fba42e24
AS
2525of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2526
2527If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2528through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2529to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2530reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2531this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2532the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2533@end deftypefn
2534
38f8b050
JR
2535@defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2536A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2537to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2538@var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2539another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2540safe:
2541
2542@smallexample
2543#define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2544@end smallexample
2545
2546Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2547example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2548for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2549@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2550Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2551
2552One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2553@var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2554loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2555force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2556immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2557instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2558register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2559@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2560into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
1a627b35
RS
2561@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2562of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
38f8b050
JR
2563
2564If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2565through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2566to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2567reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2568this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2569the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2570@end defmac
2571
abd26bfb
AS
2572@hook TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2573Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2574input reloads.
2575
2576The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2577argument.
2578
2579You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2580reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2581@end deftypefn
2582
38f8b050
JR
2583@defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2584A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2585to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2586@var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2587ordinarily be used.
2588
2589Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2590there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2591
2592The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2593smaller class.
2594
2595Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2596require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2597@end defmac
2598
2599@hook TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD
2600Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2601from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2602@samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2603from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2604term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2605directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2606register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2607destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2608source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2609reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2610and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2611intermediate register still holds the required value.
2612
2613Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2614allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2615register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2616address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2617when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2618as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2619that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2620describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2621these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2622of the scratch register(s).
2623
2624In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2625
2626For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2627and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2628@var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
2629hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2630needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2631
2632If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2633an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2634return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2635If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2636If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2637that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2638
2639If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2640perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2641closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2642required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2643copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2644
2645You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2646in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2647and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2648for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2649single-register-class
2650@c [later: or memory]
2651output constraint.
2652
2653When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2654hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2655register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2656have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2657
2658@c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2659@c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2660@c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2661@c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2662@c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2663@c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2664@c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2665@c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2666
2667
2668@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2669pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2670Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2671in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2672
2673Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2674currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2675to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2676
2677@code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2678copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2679(a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2680Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2681of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2682forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2683@end deftypefn
2684
2685@defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2686@defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2687@defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2688These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2689@code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2690
2691These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2692target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2693reload phase that it may
2694need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2695register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2696register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2697you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2698largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2699intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2700
2701If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2702intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2703was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2704class required. If the
2705requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2706@code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2707macros identically.
2708
2709The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2710Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2711can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2712@var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2713macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2714
2715If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2716intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2717@samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2718(@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
2719implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2720@samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2721register.
2722
2723These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2724register that
2725contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2726class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2727value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2728register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2729Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2730
2731@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2732pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2733Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2734in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2735
2736These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2737registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2738registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2739would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2740the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2741intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2742general registers.
2743@end defmac
2744
2745@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2746Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2747to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2748those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2749@var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2750class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2751and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2752
2753Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2754@end defmac
2755
2756@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2757Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2758allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2759If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2760defined by this macro.
2761
2762Do not define this macro if you do not define
2763@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2764@end defmac
2765
2766@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2767When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2768registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2769hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2770load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2771same as that of @var{mode}.
2772
2773This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2774bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2775in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2776registers.
2777
2778However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2779the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2780differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2781widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2782suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2783details.
2784
2785Do not define this macro if you do not define
2786@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2787is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2788@end defmac
2789
07b8f0a8
AS
2790@hook TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P
2791A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2792to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2793registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2794
2795The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2796has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
2797default should be used. Only use this target hook to some other expression
2798if pseudos allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their
2799hard registers were needed for spill registers. If this target hook returns
2800@code{false} for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
2801@file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
2802register. If there would not be another register available for reallocation,
2803you should not change the implementation of this target hook since
2804the only effect of such implementation would be to slow down register
2805allocation.
2806@end deftypefn
a8c44c52
AS
2807
2808@hook TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS
2809A target hook returns the maximum number of consecutive registers
2810of class @var{rclass} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2811
2812This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
1c7836f0 2813the value returned by @code{TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{rclass},
a8c44c52
AS
2814@var{mode})} target hook should be the maximum value of
2815@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})} for all @var{regno}
2816values in the class @var{rclass}.
2817
2818This target hook helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2819in the reload pass.
2820
2821The default version of this target hook returns the size of @var{mode}
2822in words.
2823@end deftypefn
07b8f0a8 2824
38f8b050
JR
2825@defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2826A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2827of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2828
2829This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2830the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2831should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2832@var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2833
2834This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2835in the reload pass.
2836@end defmac
2837
2838@defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2839If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2840a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2841
2842For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2843floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2844Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2845does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2846register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2847as below:
2848
2849@smallexample
2850#define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2851 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2852 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2853@end smallexample
2854@end defmac
2855
38f8b050
JR
2856@node Old Constraints
2857@section Obsolete Macros for Defining Constraints
2858@cindex defining constraints, obsolete method
2859@cindex constraints, defining, obsolete method
2860
2861Machine-specific constraints can be defined with these macros instead
2862of the machine description constructs described in @ref{Define
2863Constraints}. This mechanism is obsolete. New ports should not use
2864it; old ports should convert to the new mechanism.
2865
2866@defmac CONSTRAINT_LEN (@var{char}, @var{str})
2867For the constraint at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter
2868@var{c}, return the length. This allows you to have register class /
2869constant / extra constraints that are longer than a single letter;
2870you don't need to define this macro if you can do with single-letter
2871constraints only. The definition of this macro should use
2872DEFAULT_CONSTRAINT_LEN for all the characters that you don't want
2873to handle specially.
2874There are some sanity checks in genoutput.c that check the constraint lengths
2875for the md file, so you can also use this macro to help you while you are
2876transitioning from a byzantine single-letter-constraint scheme: when you
2877return a negative length for a constraint you want to re-use, genoutput
2878will complain about every instance where it is used in the md file.
2879@end defmac
2880
2881@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2882A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2883letters for register classes. If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2884value should be the register class corresponding to it. Otherwise,
2885the value should be @code{NO_REGS}. The register letter @samp{r},
2886corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2887to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2888@end defmac
2889
2890@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (@var{char}, @var{str})
2891Like @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}, but you also get the constraint string
2892passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between
2893different variants.
2894@end defmac
2895
2896@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2897A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2898letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2899particular ranges of integer values. If @var{c} is one of those
2900letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2901the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is
2902not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2903@var{value}.
2904@end defmac
2905
2906@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2907Like @code{CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2908string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2909between different variants.
2910@end defmac
2911
2912@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2913A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2914letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2915(@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
2916
2917If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2918@var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2919range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is not one of those
2920letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2921
2922@code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2923@code{DImode} fixed-point constants. A given letter can accept either
2924or both kinds of values. It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2925between these kinds.
2926@end defmac
2927
2928@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2929Like @code{CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2930string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2931between different variants.
2932@end defmac
2933
2934@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
2935A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2936letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
2937memory references, for the target machine. Any letter that is not
2938elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} /
2939@code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
2940may be used. Normally this macro will not be defined.
2941
2942If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
2943if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
2944constraint letter @var{c}. If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
2945constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2946
2947For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
2948in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address. Constraint
2949letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
2950@emph{not} contain a symbolic address. An alternative is specified with
2951a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output. The next
2952alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
2953does not include r0 on the output.
2954@end defmac
2955
2956@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2957Like @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, but you also get the constraint string passed
2958in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between different
2959variants.
2960@end defmac
2961
2962@defmac EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2963A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2964letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, that should
2965be treated like memory constraints by the reload pass.
2966
2967It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
2968at the start of @var{str}, the first letter of which is the letter @var{c},
2969comprises a subset of all memory references including
2970all those whose address is simply a base register. This allows the reload
2971pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
2972type of @var{c}, by copying its address into a base register.
2973
2974For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
2975memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
2976register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined via
2977@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} as representing a memory address of this type.
2978If the letter @samp{Q} is marked as @code{EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT},
2979a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any memory operand, because the
2980reload pass knows it can be reloaded by copying the memory address
2981into a base register if required. This is analogous to the way
2982an @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
2983@end defmac
2984
2985@defmac EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2986A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2987letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} /
2988@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR}, that should
2989be treated like address constraints by the reload pass.
2990
2991It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
2992at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter @var{c}, comprises
2993a subset of all memory addresses including
2994all those that consist of just a base register. This allows the reload
2995pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
2996type of @var{str}, by copying it into a base register.
2997
2998Any constraint marked as @code{EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT} can only
2999be used with the @code{address_operand} predicate. It is treated
3000analogously to the @samp{p} constraint.
3001@end defmac
3002
3003@node Stack and Calling
3004@section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
3005@cindex calling conventions
3006
3007@c prevent bad page break with this line
3008This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
3009
3010@menu
3011* Frame Layout::
3012* Exception Handling::
3013* Stack Checking::
3014* Frame Registers::
3015* Elimination::
3016* Stack Arguments::
3017* Register Arguments::
3018* Scalar Return::
3019* Aggregate Return::
3020* Caller Saves::
3021* Function Entry::
3022* Profiling::
3023* Tail Calls::
3024* Stack Smashing Protection::
3025@end menu
3026
3027@node Frame Layout
3028@subsection Basic Stack Layout
3029@cindex stack frame layout
3030@cindex frame layout
3031
3032@c prevent bad page break with this line
3033Here is the basic stack layout.
3034
3035@defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3036Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
3037pointer to a smaller address.
3038
3039When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{}'', it means that the
3040compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
3041definition used does not matter.
3042@end defmac
3043
3044@defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
3045This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
3046on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
3047@code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
3048
3049The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
3050and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
3051the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
3052to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
3053space for the next item on the stack.
3054
3055The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
3056defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
3057which is often wrong.
3058@end defmac
3059
3060@defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3061Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
3062are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
3063@end defmac
3064
3065@defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
3066Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
3067addresses on the stack.
3068@end defmac
3069
3070@defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
3071Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
3072
3073If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
3074subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3075Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
3076value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3077@c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
3078@c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
3079@end defmac
3080
3081@defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
3082Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
3083The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3084
3085On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
3086is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
3087alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
3088stack alignment and do it in the backend.
3089@end defmac
3090
3091@defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
3092Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
3093outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
3094zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
3095
3096If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3097the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
3098@end defmac
3099
3100@defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3101Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3102address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3103function.
3104
3105If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3106the first argument's address.
3107@end defmac
3108
3109@defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3110Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3111on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3112
3113The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3114length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3115machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
3116@end defmac
3117
3118@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3119A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3120stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3121@code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3122default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3123elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3124@code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3125@end defmac
3126
3127@defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3128A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3129frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3130@var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3131itself.
3132
3133If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3134of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3135address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3136@end defmac
3137
3138@defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3139If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3140setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
3141on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3142before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3143define this macro.
3144@end defmac
3145
3146@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE
3147This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3148the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3149The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3150machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3151@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3152@end deftypefn
3153
3154@defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3155A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3156address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3157of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3158You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3159as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3160@end defmac
3161
3162@defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3163A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3164address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3165the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3166frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3167@code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
3168
3169The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3170@var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3171determine the return address of other frames.
3172@end defmac
3173
3174@defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3175Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
3176from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
3177@end defmac
3178
3179@defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3180A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3181incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3182prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3183value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3184the stack.
3185
3186You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3187debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3188
3189If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3190@code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3191@end defmac
3192
3193@defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3194A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3195number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3196must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3197be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3198
3199This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3200general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3201frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3202over time.
3203@end defmac
3204
3205@defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3206A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3207number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3208only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3209someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3210terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3211@end defmac
3212
3213@hook TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC
3214This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3215contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3216info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3217@smallexample
3218(set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3219@end smallexample
3220and
3221@smallexample
3222(set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3223@end smallexample
3224to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3225the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3226the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3227@end deftypefn
3228
3229@defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3230A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3231from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3232frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3233the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3234previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3235
3236You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3237debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3238@end defmac
3239
3240@defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3241A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3242from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
3243final value should coincide with that calculated by
3244@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3245during virtual register instantiation.
3246
3247The default value for this macro is
3248@code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3249which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3250immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3251some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3252and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3253
3254You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3255want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3256DWARF 2.
3257@end defmac
3258
3259@defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3260If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3261in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3262The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3263@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3264
3265Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3266via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3267variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
3268defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3269based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3270of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3271should be defined.
3272@end defmac
3273
3274@defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3275If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3276in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3277in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3278may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3279@end defmac
3280
3281@node Exception Handling
3282@subsection Exception Handling Support
3283@cindex exception handling
3284
3285@defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3286A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3287data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3288@var{N} registers are usable.
3289
3290The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3291handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3292should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3293but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
32942 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3295
3296You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3297handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3298@end defmac
3299
3300@defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3301A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3302to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3303This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3304It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3305
3306Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3307untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3308
3309Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3310by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3311this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3312stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3313this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3314that provided by DWARF 2.
3315@end defmac
3316
3317@defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3318A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3319to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3320return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3321
3322Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3323return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3324address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3325the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3326frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3327been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3328target call frame.
3329
3330Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3331address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3332the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3333
3334If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3335define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3336@end defmac
3337
3338@defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3339If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3340to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3341exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3342using it to return to the exception handler.
3343@end defmac
3344
3345@defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3346This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3347handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3348that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3349and so may be read-only.
3350
3351@var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3352@var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3353The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3354as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3355
3356If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3357represented directly.
3358@end defmac
3359
3360@defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3361This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3362to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3363Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3364be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3365
3366This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3367handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3368of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3369to be emitted.
3370@end defmac
3371
38f8b050
JR
3372@defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3373This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3374code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3375available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3376through signal frames.
3377
3378This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3379@file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3380@file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3381@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3382for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3383the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3384save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3385evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3386the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3387
3388For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3389@code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3390@end defmac
3391
3392@defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3393This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3394call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3395usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3396
3397This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in @file{unwind-ia64.c}.
3398@var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3399@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3400for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3401@code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3402be updated in @var{fs}.
3403@end defmac
3404
3405@defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3406A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3407info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3408linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3409@end defmac
3410
3411@node Stack Checking
3412@subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3413
3414GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3415stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3416three ways:
3417
3418@enumerate
3419@item
3420If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3421will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3422at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3423other special processing.
3424
3425@item
3426If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3427@code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3428that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3429static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3430in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3431stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3432approach below.
3433
3434@item
3435If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3436``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3437@end enumerate
3438
3439If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3440GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3441@option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3442dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3443
3444@defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3445A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3446machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3447is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3448checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3449value of this macro is zero.
3450@end defmac
3451
3452@defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3453A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3454in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3455like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3456approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
3457@end defmac
3458
3459@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3460An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3461instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3462define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3463the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3464of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3465@end defmac
3466
3467@defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3468An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3469when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3470contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3471thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3472is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3473default value of this macro is zero.
3474@end defmac
3475
3476@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3477The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3478languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 75 words
3479with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
34808192 bytes with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for
3481most machines.
3482@end defmac
3483
3484The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3485nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3486in the opposite case.
3487
3488@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3489The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3490instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3491stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3492checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3493default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3494systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3495@end defmac
3496
3497@defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3498GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3499represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3500space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3501You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3502use the default of four words.
3503@end defmac
3504
3505@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3506The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3507fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3508@option{-fstack-check}.
3509GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3510normally not need to override that default.
3511@end defmac
3512
3513@need 2000
3514@node Frame Registers
3515@subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3516
3517@c prevent bad page break with this line
3518This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3519
3520@defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3521The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3522fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3523the hardware determines which register this is.
3524@end defmac
3525
3526@defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3527The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3528access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3529hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3530choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3531@end defmac
3532
3533@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3534On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3535offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3536allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3537between these two locations). On those machines, define
3538@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3539be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3540@code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3541used for the frame pointer.
3542
3543You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3544is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3545the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3546completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3547definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3548@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3549or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3550
3551Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3552@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3553@end defmac
3554
3555@defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3556The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3557the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3558frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3559register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3560wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3561pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3562@code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3563(@pxref{Elimination}).
3564@end defmac
3565
e3339d0f
JM
3566@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3567Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3568@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3569the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3570== FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3571definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3572@end defmac
3573
3574@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3575Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3576@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3577same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3578ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3579definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3580@end defmac
3581
38f8b050
JR
3582@defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3583The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3584access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3585machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3586pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3587to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3588@code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3589
3590Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3591address from the stack.
3592@end defmac
3593
3594@defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3595@defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3596Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3597register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3598function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3599number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3600these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3601not be defined.
3602
3603The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3604
3605If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3606defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3607@end defmac
3608
3609@hook TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN
3610This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3611targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3612nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3613attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3614those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3615
3616The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3617
3618If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3619provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3620Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3621from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3622will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3623@findex stack_pointer_rtx
3624@findex frame_pointer_rtx
3625@findex arg_pointer_rtx
3626The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3627@code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3628to refer to those items.
3629@end deftypefn
3630
3631@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3632This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3633saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3634DWARF2 exception handling.
3635
3636Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3637exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3638extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3639in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3640used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3641routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3642registers that are not call-saved.
3643
3644If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3645@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3646@end defmac
3647
3648@defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3649
3650This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3651for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3652
3653If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3654@code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3655@end defmac
3656
3657@defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3658
3659Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3660is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3661Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3662column number to use instead.
3663
3664See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
3665@end defmac
3666
3667@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3668
3669Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3670used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3671debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3672should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3673@code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3674
3675@end defmac
3676
3677@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3678
3679Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3680that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3681should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3682.eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
3683return @code{@var{regno}}.
3684
3685@end defmac
3686
cca2207a
L
3687@defmac REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3688
3689Define this macro if the target stores register values as
3690@code{_Unwind_Word} type in unwind context. It should be defined if
3691target register size is larger than the size of @code{void *}. The
3692default is to store register values as @code{void *} type.
3693
3694@end defmac
3695
3696@defmac ASSUME_EXTENDED_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3697
3698Define this macro to be 1 if the target always uses extended unwind
3699context with version, args_size and by_value fields. If it is undefined,
3700it will be defined to 1 when @code{REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT} is
3701defined and 0 otherwise.
3702
3703@end defmac
3704
38f8b050
JR
3705@node Elimination
3706@subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3707
3708@c prevent bad page break with this line
3709This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3710
3711@hook TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
3712This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3713a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3714value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3715
3716This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3717according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3718constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3719to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3720Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3721pointer.
3722
3723In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3724without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3725automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3726@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} returns. You don't need to worry about
3727them.
3728
3729In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3730register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3731fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3732
3733Default return value is @code{false}.
3734@end deftypefn
3735
3736@findex get_frame_size
3737@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3738A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3739between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3740the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3741such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3742registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3743
3744If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3745need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3746@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
3747case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3748@end defmac
3749
3750@defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3751If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3752eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3753defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3754references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3755
3756The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3757of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3758
3759On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3760the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3761must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3762replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3763depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3764
3765In this case, you might specify:
3766@smallexample
3767#define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3768@{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3769 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3770 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3771@end smallexample
3772
3773Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3774specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3775@end defmac
3776
3777@hook TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE
3778This target hook should returns @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3779try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3780@var{to_reg}. This target hook need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3781is defined, and will usually be @code{true}, since most of the cases
3782preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3783knows about.
3784
3785Default return value is @code{true}.
3786@end deftypefn
3787
3788@defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3789This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3790specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3791registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3792defined.
3793@end defmac
3794
3795@node Stack Arguments
3796@subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3797@cindex arguments on stack
3798@cindex stack arguments
3799
3800The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3801on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3802control passing certain arguments in registers.
3803
3804@hook TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
3805This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3806prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3807passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3808cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3809The default is to not promote prototypes.
3810@end deftypefn
3811
3812@defmac PUSH_ARGS
3813A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3814outgoing arguments.
3815If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3816That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3817allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3818it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3819@end defmac
3820
3821@defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3822A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3823last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3824defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3825and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3826@end defmac
3827
3828@defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3829A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3830stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3831
3832On some machines, the definition
3833
3834@smallexample
3835#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3836@end smallexample
3837
3838@noindent
3839will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3840to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3841alignment. Then the definition should be
3842
3843@smallexample
3844#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3845@end smallexample
4a6336ad 3846
64ad7c99 3847If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
38f8b050
JR
3848@end defmac
3849
3850@findex current_function_outgoing_args_size
3851@defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3852A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3853will be computed and placed into the variable
3854@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3855onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3856increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3857
3858Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3859is not proper.
3860@end defmac
3861
3862@defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3863Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3864allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3865registers.
3866
3867The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3868arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3869which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3870The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3871of the function.
3872
3873This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3874machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3875which.
3876@end defmac
3877@c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3878@c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3879
3880@defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3881Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3882caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3883when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3884if the function called is a library function.
3885
3886If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3887whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3888@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.
3889@end defmac
3890
3891@defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3892Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3893stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3894@c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3895@c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3896
3897Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3898stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3899suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3900stack in its natural location.
3901@end defmac
3902
893d13d5 3903@hook TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS
38f8b050
JR
3904This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3905a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3906and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3907
3908@var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3909the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3910@code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3911From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3912
3913@var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3914describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3915@code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3916From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3917arguments (if known).
3918
3919When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3920will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3921you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3922by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3923a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3924in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3925
893d13d5 3926@var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
38f8b050
JR
3927stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3928argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3929
3930On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
893d13d5 3931of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
38f8b050
JR
3932calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3933the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3934convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3935arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3936nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3937@var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3938number of arguments.
3939@end deftypefn
3940
3941@defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3942A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3943pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3944when compiling a function call.
3945
3946@var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3947have been accumulated.
3948
3949On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3950that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3951that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3952call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3953appropriate.
3954@end defmac
3955
3956@node Register Arguments
3957@subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3958@cindex arguments in registers
3959@cindex registers arguments
3960
3961This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3962types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3963the stack.
3964
b25b9e8f
NF
3965@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG
3966Return an RTX indicating whether a function argument is passed in a
3967register and if so, which register.
38f8b050 3968
b25b9e8f 3969The arguments are @var{ca}, which summarizes all the previous
38f8b050
JR
3970arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3971the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3972(which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
b25b9e8f
NF
3973which is @code{true} for an ordinary argument and @code{false} for
3974nameless arguments that correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called
3975function's prototype. @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a
3976syntax error has previously occurred.
38f8b050 3977
b25b9e8f
NF
3978The return value is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3979register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the argument
3980on the stack.
38f8b050
JR
3981
3982The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
3983used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
3984@code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
3985@code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
3986describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
3987@code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3988register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
3989register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
3990second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
3991the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
3992As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
3993RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
3994argument is also stored on the stack.
3995
b25b9e8f 3996The last time this hook is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
38f8b050
JR
3997VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
3998pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
3999
4000@cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
b25b9e8f
NF
4001The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a
4002machine where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to
4003cause nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is
4004done by making @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever
4005@var{named} is @code{false}.
4006
4007@cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
4008@cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
38f8b050
JR
4009You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
4010in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
4011type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
b25b9e8f 4012is not defined and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
38f8b050
JR
4013argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
4014defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
4015a register.
b25b9e8f 4016@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
4017
4018@hook TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK
4019This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
4020solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
4021definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
4022documentation.
4023@end deftypefn
4024
b25b9e8f
NF
4025@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG
4026Define this hook if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
38f8b050
JR
4027that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
4028necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
4029argument.
4030
b25b9e8f
NF
4031For such machines, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in
4032which the caller passes the value, and
4033@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should be defined in a similar
4034fashion to tell the function being called where the arguments will
4035arrive.
38f8b050 4036
b25b9e8f
NF
4037If @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined,
4038@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} serves both purposes.
4039@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
4040
4041@hook TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES
4042This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
4043argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
4044arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
4045pushed on the stack.
4046
4047On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
4048registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
4049first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
4050on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
4051structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
4052in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
4053compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
4054
b25b9e8f 4055@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
38f8b050 4056register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
b25b9e8f 4057@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
38f8b050
JR
4058@end deftypefn
4059
ec9f85e5 4060@hook TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE
38f8b050
JR
4061This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
4062position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
4063predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
4064passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
4065
4066If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
4067pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
4068The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
4069to that type.
4070@end deftypefn
4071
4072@hook TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES
4073The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4074known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
4075function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4076by the caller.
4077
4078For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
4079determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4080not be generated.
4081
4082The default version of this hook always returns false.
4083@end deftypefn
4084
4085@defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
b25b9e8f
NF
4086A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument
4087of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some
4088target machines, the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number
4089of bytes of argument so far.
38f8b050
JR
4090
4091There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4092arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4093variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4094arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4095@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4096should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4097@end defmac
4098
4099@defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4100If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4101function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4102created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4103reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4104If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4105@var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4106@end defmac
4107
4108@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4109A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4110@var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4111variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4112is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4113the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4114For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4115declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4116@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4117being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4118arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4119parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
4120@var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4121
4122When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4123@var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4124contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4125an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4126macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4127never both of them at once.
4128@end defmac
4129
4130@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4131Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4132it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4133@code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4134is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
41350)} is used instead.
4136@end defmac
4137
4138@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4139Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4140finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4141undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4142
4143The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4144with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
4145argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4146@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4147@c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4148@c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
4149@end defmac
4150
b25b9e8f
NF
4151@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE
4152This hook updates the summarizer variable pointed to by @var{ca} to
4153advance past an argument in the argument list. The values @var{mode},
4154@var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument. Once this is done,
4155the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing the @emph{following}
4156argument with @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
38f8b050 4157
b25b9e8f 4158This hook need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
38f8b050
JR
4159on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4160used for arguments without any special help.
b25b9e8f 4161@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
4162
4163@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4164If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4165offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4166which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4167slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4168top.
4169@end defmac
4170
4171@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4172If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4173to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4174@code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4175@code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4176
123148b5
BS
4177The @emph{amount} of padding is not controlled by this macro, but by the
4178target hook @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY}. It is
4179always just enough to reach the next multiple of that boundary.
38f8b050
JR
4180
4181This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4182For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4183big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4184constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4185@end defmac
4186
4187@defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4188If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4189implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4190next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4191controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4192arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4193@end defmac
4194
4195@defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4196Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4197memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4198macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4199machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4200@code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4201registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4202a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4203required.
4204@end defmac
4205
c2ed6cf8 4206@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY
2b0d3573 4207This hook returns the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
c2ed6cf8
NF
4208with the specified mode and type. The default hook returns
4209@code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4210@end deftypefn
38f8b050 4211
123148b5
BS
4212@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY
4213
38f8b050
JR
4214@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4215A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4216register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4217@emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4218the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4219used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4220stack.
4221@end defmac
4222
4223@hook TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG
4224This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4225as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4226arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4227to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4228AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4229registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4230point register.
4231
4232The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4233false.
4234@end deftypefn
4235
4236@hook TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST
4237This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4238The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4239@end deftypefn
4240
07a5b2bc 4241@hook TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P
38f8b050
JR
4242This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4243to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4244variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
07a5b2bc 4245to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
38f8b050 4246variable.
07a5b2bc 4247The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
38f8b050
JR
4248this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4249internal type.
4250If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4251Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4252macro to iterate through all types.
4253@end deftypefn
4254
4255@hook TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST
4256This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4257@var{fndecl}.
4258The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4259@end deftypefn
4260
4261@hook TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE
4262This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4263type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4264@code{NULL_TREE}.
4265@end deftypefn
4266
4267@hook TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR
4268This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4269@code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4270arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4271@code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4272@end deftypefn
4273
4274@hook TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE
4275Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4276with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4277hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4278@end deftypefn
4279
7352c013
RG
4280@hook TARGET_REF_MAY_ALIAS_ERRNO
4281
38f8b050
JR
4282@hook TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4283Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4284insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4285considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4286must work.
4287
4288The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4289required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4290Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4291code in @file{optabs.c}.
4292@end deftypefn
4293
4294@hook TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4295Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4296insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4297must have move patterns for this mode.
4298@end deftypefn
4299
0f6d54f7
RS
4300@hook TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4301
38f8b050
JR
4302@hook TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P
4303Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4304small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4305@var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4306in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4307In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4308for any mode.
4309
4310On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4311insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4312to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4313if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4314insn.
4315
4316Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4317in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4318the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4319classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4320registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4321registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4322SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4323strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4324machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4325
2b0d3573 4326The default version of this hook returns false for any mode. It is always
38f8b050
JR
4327safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4328unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4329that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4330to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4331of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4332@end deftypefn
4333
e692f276
RH
4334@hook TARGET_FLAGS_REGNUM
4335
38f8b050
JR
4336@node Scalar Return
4337@subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4338@cindex return values in registers
4339@cindex values, returned by functions
4340@cindex scalars, returned as values
4341
4342This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4343values---values that can fit in registers.
4344
4345@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE
4346
4347Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4348returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4349representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4350representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4351function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4352compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4353Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4354a function returns a value.
4355
4356On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4357(Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4358place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4359@code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4360The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
b25b9e8f 4361multiple places. See @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
38f8b050
JR
4362@code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4363location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4364the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4365that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4366port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4367@samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4368
4369If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4370the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4371@var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4372
4373If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4374node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4375pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4376convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4377known.
4378
4379Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4380which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4381the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4382different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4383
4384@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4385aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
4386@code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4387@end deftypefn
4388
4389@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4390This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4391a new target instead.
4392@end defmac
4393
4394@defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4395A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4396function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4397
4398Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4399support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4400specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4401compiled.
4402@end defmac
4403
4404@hook TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE
4405Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
ff2ce160 4406function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
38f8b050
JR
4407
4408The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
ff2ce160 4409library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
38f8b050
JR
4410representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4411
4412If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4413@end deftypefn
4414
4415@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4416A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4417register in which the values of called function may come back.
4418
4419A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4420second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4421recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4422suffices:
4423
4424@smallexample
4425#define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4426@end smallexample
4427
4428If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4429function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4430should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4431
4432This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4433for a new target instead.
4434@end defmac
4435
4436@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P
4437A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4438register in which the values of called function may come back.
4439
4440A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4441second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4442recognized by this target hook.
4443
4444If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4445function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4446should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4447
4448If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4449@end deftypefn
4450
4451@defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4452Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4453need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4454saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4455@end defmac
4456
4457@hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB
4458This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4459at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4460padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4461is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4462
4463Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4464be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4465or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
44664-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4467@code{SImode} rtx.
4468@end deftypefn
4469
4470@node Aggregate Return
4471@subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4472@cindex aggregates as return values
4473@cindex large return values
4474@cindex returning aggregate values
4475@cindex structure value address
4476
4477When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4478cases), the value is not returned according to
4479@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4480caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4481should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4482address}.
4483
4484This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4485memory.
4486
4487@hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY
4488This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4489function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4490Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4491will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4492libcalls.
4493
4494Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4495by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4496takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
4497possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4498definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4499values, and 0 otherwise.
4500
4501Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4502be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4503to indicate this.
4504@end deftypefn
4505
4506@defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4507Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4508in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4509only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4510If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4511and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4512target hook.
4513
4514If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4515@end defmac
4516
4517@hook TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX
4518This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4519address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4520passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
4521be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4522hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4523argument.
4524
4525On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4526is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4527caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4528be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4529@var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4530the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4531the caller.
4532
4533If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4534stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4535@var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4536structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
4537to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4538@end deftypefn
4539
4540@defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4541Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4542for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4543the address of a static variable containing the value.
4544
4545Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4546pass an address to the subroutine.
4547
4548This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4549nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4550@end defmac
4551
ffa88471
SE
4552@hook TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE
4553
4554@hook TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE
4555
38f8b050
JR
4556@node Caller Saves
4557@subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4558
4559If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
4560makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4561must live across calls.
4562
4563@defmac CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
4564A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
4565a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
4566restoring it around each function call. The expression should be 1 when
4567this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
4568
4569If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
4570machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
4571@end defmac
4572
4573@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4574A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4575of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4576@var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4577returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4578will select the smallest suitable mode.
4579@end defmac
4580
4581@node Function Entry
4582@subsection Function Entry and Exit
4583@cindex function entry and exit
4584@cindex prologue
4585@cindex epilogue
4586
4587This section describes the macros that output function entry
4588(@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4589
4590@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE
4591If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4592function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4593initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4594saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4595local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4596stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4597
4598The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4599macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4600
4601@findex regs_ever_live
4602To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4603@code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4604@var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4605prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4606call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4607@code{regs_ever_live}.)
4608
4609On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4610not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4611they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4612appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4613registers are used in the function.
4614
4615@findex frame_pointer_needed
4616On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4617function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4618pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4619frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4620@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4621time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4622
4623The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4624required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4625listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4626order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4627stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4628the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4629for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4630compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4631or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4632need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4633@end deftypefn
4634
4635@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE
4636If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4637prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4638emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4639emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4640@end deftypefn
4641
4642@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE
4643If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4644epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4645emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4646emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4647@end deftypefn
4648
4649@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE
4650If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4651function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4652registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4653called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4654same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4655registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4656@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4657
4658On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4659of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4660instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4661@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4662
4663Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4664@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4665switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4666define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4667target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4668condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4669
4670On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4671function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4672two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4673is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4674@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4675a function that needs a frame pointer.
4676
4677Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4678@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4679The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4680function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4681
4682On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4683others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4684given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4685number of arguments.
4686
4687@findex current_function_pops_args
4688Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4689functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4690needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4691function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4692@code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4693@end deftypefn
4694
4695@itemize @bullet
4696@item
4697@findex current_function_pretend_args_size
4698A region of @code{current_function_pretend_args_size} bytes of
4699uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4700stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4701if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4702arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4703yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4704region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4705registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4706features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4707
4708@item
4709An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4710The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4711the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4712machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4713in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4714a save area.
4715
4716@item
4717A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4718boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4719this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4720save area closer to the top of the stack.
4721
4722@item
4723@cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4724Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4725@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4726argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4727@end itemize
4728
4729@defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4730Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4731instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4732pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4733adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4734default is 0.
4735
4736Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4737frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4738stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4739compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4740@end defmac
4741
4742@defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4743Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4744used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4745pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4746@end defmac
4747
4748@defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4749Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4750used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4751on entry to an exception edge.
4752@end defmac
4753
4754@defmac DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
4755Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
4756instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''. The
4757definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
4758representing the number of delay slots there.
4759@end defmac
4760
4761@defmac ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
4762A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
4763slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
4764
4765The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
4766being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
4767eligibility). It is never negative and is always less than the number
4768of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
4769If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
4770may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot. Also, other insns may
4771(at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
4772slot.
4773
4774@findex current_function_epilogue_delay_list
4775@findex final_scan_insn
4776The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
4777list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in the variable
4778@code{current_function_epilogue_delay_list}. The insn for the first
4779delay slot comes first in the list. Your definition of the macro
4780@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by
4781outputting the insns in this list, usually by calling
4782@code{final_scan_insn}.
4783
4784You need not define this macro if you did not define
4785@code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
4786@end defmac
4787
4788@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4789A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4790function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4791inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4792adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4793the real function.
4794
4795First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4796contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4797contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4798in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4799e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4800all other incoming arguments.
4801
4802Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4803made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4804adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4805
4806@smallexample
4807p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4808@end smallexample
4809
4810After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4811@code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4812not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4813return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4814
4815The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4816the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4817of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4818and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4819
4820The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4821have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4822some targets, but probably not.
4823
4824If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4825front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4826@var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4827not support varargs.
4828@end deftypefn
4829
4830@hook TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4831A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4832to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4833arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4834generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4835previously exposed.
4836@end deftypefn
4837
4838@node Profiling
4839@subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4840@cindex profiling, code generation
4841
4842These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4843
4844@defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4845A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4846assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4847
4848@findex mcount
4849The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4850your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4851compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4852compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4853
4854Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4855variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4856@samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4857the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4858@end defmac
4859
4860@defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4861A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4862code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4863not support profiling.
4864@end defmac
4865
4866@defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4867Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4868@code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4869allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4870implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4871@var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4872@end defmac
4873
4874@defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4875Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4876the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4877@end defmac
4878
4879@node Tail Calls
4880@subsection Permitting tail calls
4881@cindex tail calls
4882
4883@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL
4884True if it is ok to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4885call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4886or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4887
4888It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4889tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4890during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4891as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4892``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4893may vary greatly between different architectures.
4894@end deftypefn
4895
4896@hook TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY
4897Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4898function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4899cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4900registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4901TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4902FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4903@end deftypefn
4904
4905@node Stack Smashing Protection
4906@subsection Stack smashing protection
4907@cindex stack smashing protection
4908
4909@hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD
4910This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
4911for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
4912runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4913that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
4914variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4915
4916The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4917@samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4918@end deftypefn
4919
4920@hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL
4921This hook returns a tree expression that alerts the runtime that the
4922stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
4923involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
4924
4925The default version of this hook invokes a function called
4926@samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
4927normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4928@end deftypefn
4929
7458026b
ILT
4930@hook TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK
4931
38f8b050
JR
4932@node Varargs
4933@section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4934@cindex varargs implementation
4935
4936GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4937@code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
4938on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
4939varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4940conditionals to include it.
4941
4942ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
4943the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
4944implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
4945to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
4946@code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
4947supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4948
4949However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
4950the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
4951below.
4952
4953@defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
4954Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
4955that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
4956versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
4957you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
4958
4959On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
4960control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
4961other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
4962found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4963
4964Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
4965beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
4966@code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
4967This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
4968to use them for its own purposes.
4969@c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
4970@c 10feb93
4971@end defmac
4972
38f8b050 4973@defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
c59a0a1d 4974This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
38f8b050
JR
4975argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
4976returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
4977argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
4978fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
4979verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
4980of the current function.
4981@end defmac
4982
4983@defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
4984Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
4985passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
4986has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
4987specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
4988with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
4989
4990@code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
4991considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
4992kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
4993
4994The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
4995interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
4996@end defmac
4997
4998These machine description macros help implement varargs:
4999
5000@hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS
5001If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
5002@code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
5003beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
5004return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
5005to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
5006@end deftypefn
5007
5008@hook TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
5009This target hook offers an alternative to using
5010@code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
5011@code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
5012register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
5013have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
5014use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
5015pass all their arguments on the stack.
5016
5017The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
5018structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
5019named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
5020last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
5021
5022The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
5023argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
5024store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
5025variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
5026store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
5027frame.
5028
5029Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5030compile time without knowing their data types,
5031@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5032have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5033for all data types.
5034
5035If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5036arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5037happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5038end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5039not generate any instructions in this case.
5040@end deftypefn
5041
5042@hook TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
5043Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5044argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5045
b25b9e8f 5046This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
38f8b050
JR
5047is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5048@code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5049arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5050but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5051then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5052except the last are treated as named.
5053
5054You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5055@end deftypefn
5056
5057@hook TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
5058If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5059@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5060@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5061defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5062@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5063Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5064@end deftypefn
5065
5066@node Trampolines
5067@section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5068@cindex trampolines for nested functions
5069@cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5070
5071A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5072when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5073the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
5074tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
5075trampoline.
5076
5077The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5078address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5079the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5080two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5081exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5082machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5083two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5084operands.
5085
5086The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5087parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5088immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5089simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5090proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5091may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5092separately.
5093
5094@hook TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE
5095This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5096on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5097the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5098label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5099
5100If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5101for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5102code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5103to generate it on the spot.
5104@end deftypefn
5105
5106@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5107Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5108(@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5109@end defmac
5110
5111@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5112A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5113@end defmac
5114
5115@defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5116Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5117
5118If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5119is used for aligning trampolines.
5120@end defmac
5121
5122@hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT
5123This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5124@var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5125is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5126RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5127when it is called.
5128
5129If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5130first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5131from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
ff2ce160 5132Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
38f8b050
JR
5133trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5134to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5135
5136If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
ff2ce160 5137enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
38f8b050
JR
5138initializing the trampoline proper.
5139@end deftypefn
5140
5141@hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS
5142This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5143the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5144memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5145the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5146address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5147be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5148If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5149@end deftypefn
5150
5151Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5152separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5153fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5154jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5155
5156Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5157the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5158make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5159subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5160latter makes initialization faster.
5161
5162To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5163the following macro.
5164
5165@defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5166If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5167cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5168typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5169@var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5170@end defmac
5171
38f8b050
JR
5172To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5173you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5174cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5175beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5176its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5177
5178@defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5179Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5180work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5181which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
5182@code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5183
5184If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5185C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5186special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5187statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5188global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5189special assembler code.
5190@end defmac
5191
5192@node Library Calls
5193@section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5194@cindex library subroutine names
5195@cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5196
5197@c prevent bad page break with this line
5198Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5199
5200@defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5201This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5202expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
5203provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5204are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5205@end defmac
5206
5207@findex set_optab_libfunc
5208@findex init_one_libfunc
5209@hook TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS
5210This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5211existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5212@code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5213@code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5214library routines.
5215
5216The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5217@end deftypefn
5218
cdbf4541
BS
5219@hook TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX
5220
38f8b050
JR
5221@defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5222This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5223implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5224mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5225return a tristate.
5226
5227GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5228comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5229don't need to define this macro.
5230@end defmac
5231
5232@defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5233This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5234functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5235operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5236and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5237If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5238@minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
5239in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5240@end defmac
5241
38f8b050
JR
5242@cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5243@findex matherr
5244@defmac TARGET_EDOM
5245The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5246expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5247deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5248@file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5249system.
5250
5251If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5252domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5253error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5254there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5255that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5256@end defmac
5257
5258@cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5259@defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5260Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5261refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5262@code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5263macro, a reasonable default is used.
5264@end defmac
5265
5266@cindex C99 math functions, implicit usage
5267@defmac TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
5268When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize @code{sin} calls into
5269@code{sinf} and similarly for other functions defined by C99 standard. The
5270default is zero because a number of existing systems lack support for these
5271functions in their runtime so this macro needs to be redefined to one on
5272systems that do support the C99 runtime.
5273@end defmac
5274
5275@cindex sincos math function, implicit usage
5276@defmac TARGET_HAS_SINCOS
5277When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize calls to @code{sin}
5278and @code{cos} with the same argument to a call to @code{sincos}. The
5279default is zero. The target has to provide the following functions:
5280@smallexample
5281void sincos(double x, double *sin, double *cos);
5282void sincosf(float x, float *sin, float *cos);
5283void sincosl(long double x, long double *sin, long double *cos);
5284@end smallexample
5285@end defmac
5286
5287@defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
5288Define this macro to generate code for Objective-C message sending using
5289the calling convention of the NeXT system. This calling convention
5290involves passing the object, the selector and the method arguments all
5291at once to the method-lookup library function.
5292
5293The default calling convention passes just the object and the selector
5294to the lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5295@end defmac
5296
5297@node Addressing Modes
5298@section Addressing Modes
5299@cindex addressing modes
5300
5301@c prevent bad page break with this line
5302This is about addressing modes.
5303
5304@defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5305@defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5306@defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5307@defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5308A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5309pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5310@end defmac
5311
5312@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5313@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5314A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5315post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5316the size of the memory operand.
5317@end defmac
5318
5319@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5320@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5321A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5322post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5323@end defmac
5324
5325@defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5326A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5327is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5328@code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5329is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
ff2ce160 5330constant addresses are supported.
38f8b050
JR
5331@end defmac
5332
5333@defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5334@code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5335accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5336known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5337expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5338@code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5339@end defmac
5340
5341@defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5342A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5343memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5344the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5345accept.
5346@end defmac
5347
5348@hook TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
5349A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5350address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5351
5352Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5353non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5354desired by the caller.
5355
5356The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5357that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5358considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5359kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5360must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5361up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5362register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5363if the array holds @code{-1}.
5364
5365The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5366accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5367register is required.
5368
5369Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5370and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5371constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5372specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5373recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5374
5375Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5376sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5377@code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5378naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5379be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5380
5381@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5382On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5383the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
5384target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5385into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
5386@code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5387@code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5388Format}.
5389
5390@cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5391Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5392this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5393has this syntax:
5394
5395@example
5396#define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5397@end example
5398
5399@noindent
5400and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5401address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
6f7b223b
PK
5402
5403@findex REG_OK_STRICT
5404Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5405macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
5406@code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5407that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5408
38f8b050
JR
5409Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5410files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5411@end deftypefn
5412
5413@defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5414A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5415character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5416letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5417@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
5418support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5419semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5420preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5421@code{'m'} constraint.
5422@end defmac
5423
5424@defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5425A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5426or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5427can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5428@code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5429
5430It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5431that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5432
5433The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5434a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5435@end defmac
5436
5437@hook TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5438This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5439operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5440address.
5441
5442@findex break_out_memory_refs
5443@var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5444and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5445@var{x}.
5446
5447The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5448@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5449should return the new @var{x}.
5450
5451It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address.
5452The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, it
5453is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5454a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5455strategy can generate better code.
5456@end deftypefn
5457
5458@defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5459A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5460that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5461@var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5462It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5463performance reasons.
5464
5465For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5466reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5467registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5468processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5469needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5470@code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5471generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5472be shared.
5473
5474@emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5475to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5476and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5477of reload internals.
5478
5479@emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5480previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5481then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5482
5483@findex push_reload
5484The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5485need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5486suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5487
5488The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5489@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5490should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5491This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5492@code{push_reload}.
5493
5494@findex strict_memory_address_p
5495The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5496the address has become legitimate.
5497
5498@findex copy_rtx
5499If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5500this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
5501single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5502top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5503It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5504address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5505@end defmac
5506
5507@hook TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P
5508This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} can have
5509different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5510reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5511but not others.
5512
5513Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5514effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5515of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5516addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5517
5518You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5519
5520The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5521@end deftypefn
5522
5523@defmac GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS (@var{addr}, @var{label})
5524A C statement or compound statement with a conditional @code{goto
5525@var{label};} executed if memory address @var{x} (an RTX) can have
5526different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5527reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5528but not others.
5529
5530Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5531effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5532of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5533addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5534
5535You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5536
5537These are obsolete macros, replaced by the
5538@code{TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P} target hook.
5539@end defmac
5540
1a627b35
RS
5541@hook TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P
5542This hook returns true if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for a
5543@var{mode}-mode immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5544@var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.
5545
5546The default definition returns true.
5547@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
5548
5549@hook TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5550This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5551@code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5552macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5553references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5554addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5555the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5556into their original form.
5557@end deftypefn
5558
5559@hook TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM
5560This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
fbbf66e7
RS
5561should not) be spilled to the constant pool. @var{mode} is the mode
5562of @var{x}.
5563
5564The default version of this hook returns false.
38f8b050
JR
5565
5566The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5567deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5568from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5569holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5570of TLS symbols for various targets.
5571@end deftypefn
5572
5573@hook TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P
5574This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5575be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5576of @var{x}.
5577
5578The default version returns false for all constants.
5579@end deftypefn
5580
89356d17 5581@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL
38f8b050
JR
5582This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements reciprocal of
5583the builtin function with builtin function code @var{fn}, or
5584@code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available. @var{md_fn} is true
5585when @var{fn} is a code of a machine-dependent builtin function. When
5586@var{sqrt} is true, additional optimizations that apply only to the reciprocal
5587of a square root function are performed, and only reciprocals of @code{sqrt}
5588function are valid.
5589@end deftypefn
5590
5591@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD
5592This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5593address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5594used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5595@var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5596
5597The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5598@var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5599the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5600@code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5601two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5602@var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5603the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5604from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5605@var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5606@var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5607@var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5608
5609If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5610to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5611use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5612@code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5613should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5614described above.
5615If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5616the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5617log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5618@end deftypefn
5619
5620@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN
5621This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5622widening multiplication of the even elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5623
5624If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5625@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD} target hook when vectorizing
5626widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5627preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5628@code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5629@end deftypefn
5630
5631@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD
5632This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5633widening multiplication of the odd elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5634
5635If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5636@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN} target hook when vectorizing
5637widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5638preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5639@code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5640@end deftypefn
5641
5642@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST
5643Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
ff2ce160 5644For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
720f5239 5645misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
38f8b050
JR
5646@end deftypefn
5647
5648@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE
5649Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5650@end deftypefn
5651
5a3c0068 5652@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_VEC_PERM_CONST_OK
5dea5b2a 5653Return true if a vector created for @code{vec_perm_const} is valid.
38f8b050
JR
5654@end deftypefn
5655
5656@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION
5657This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
5658input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
5659The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5660specifies how the conversion is to be applied
5661(truncation, rounding, etc.).
5662
5663If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5664@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5665conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5666@end deftypefn
5667
5668@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION
5669This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5670vectorized variant of the builtin function with builtin function code
5671@var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5672The value of @var{fndecl} is the builtin function declaration. The
5673return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5674@var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5675@end deftypefn
5676
5677@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT
5678This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5679store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5680parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5681the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5682parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5683@end deftypefn
5684
cc4b5170
RG
5685@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE
5686This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5687mode @var{mode}. The default is
5688equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
26983c22
L
5689transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5690@end deftypefn
5691
767f865f
RG
5692@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES
5693This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5694after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5695mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5696The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5697@end deftypefn
5698
0a35513e
AH
5699@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_TM_LOAD
5700
5701@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_TM_STORE
5702
aec7ae7d
JJ
5703@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_GATHER
5704Target builtin that implements vector gather operation. @var{mem_vectype}
5705is the vector type of the load and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
5706the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
5707The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize gather
5708loads.
5709@end deftypefn
5710
38f8b050
JR
5711@node Anchored Addresses
5712@section Anchored Addresses
5713@cindex anchored addresses
5714@cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5715
5716GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5717For example, if we have:
5718
5719@smallexample
5720static int a, b, c;
5721int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5722@end smallexample
5723
5724the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5725addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5726it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5727the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5728be something like:
5729
5730@smallexample
5731int foo (void)
5732@{
5733 register int *xr = &x;
5734 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5735@}
5736@end smallexample
5737
5738(which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5739``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5740
5741The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5742in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5743section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5744or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5745
5746@hook TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5747The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5748On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5749applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5750for every mode. The default value is 0.
5751@end deftypevr
5752
5753@hook TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5754Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5755offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5756value is 0.
5757@end deftypevr
5758
5759@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR
5760Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5761@code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5762The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5763of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5764
5765If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5766it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5767If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5768is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5769@end deftypefn
5770
5771@hook TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P
5772Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
5773@var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
5774@samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5775
5776The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5777intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5778or target-specific sections.
5779@end deftypefn
5780
5781@node Condition Code
5782@section Condition Code Status
5783@cindex condition code status
5784
5785The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5786two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5787
5788The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5789(@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5790clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5791register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5792architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5793most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5794most RISC machines.
5795
5796The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
5797the definition and use of the condition code, which need to be in adjacent
5798insns for machines using @code{(cc0)}. This can prevent important
5799optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5800is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5801three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
5802scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5803separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5804
5805For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5806represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
5807condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
5808condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5809or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5810Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5811that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
5812
5813Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
5814specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
5815interested in most macros in this section.
5816
5817@menu
5818* CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
5819* MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
ac7eb5c6 5820* Cond Exec Macros:: Macros to control conditional execution.
38f8b050
JR
5821@end menu
5822
5823@node CC0 Condition Codes
5824@subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
5825@findex cc0
5826
5827@findex cc_status
5828The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5829describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5830the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5831variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5832currently based, and several standard flags.
5833
5834Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5835description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5836information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5837
5838@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
5839C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5840component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5841
5842This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5843@end defmac
5844
5845@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5846A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5847The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5848the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5849define this macro to initialize it.
5850
5851This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5852@end defmac
5853
5854@defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
5855A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5856appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5857this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5858code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5859set @code{(cc0)}.
5860
5861This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5862
5863If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5864other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5865invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5866reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5867registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5868@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5869insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5870based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5871value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5872this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5873@samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5874@code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5875condition code value.
5876
5877The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5878with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5879@code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5880constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5881insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5882@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5883@code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5884
5885A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5886that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5887@samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5888two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
5889@end defmac
5890
5891@node MODE_CC Condition Codes
5892@subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
5893@findex CCmode
5894@findex MODE_CC
5895
5896@defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
5897On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
5898than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
5899code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
5900when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
5901bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
5902branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
5903this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
5904record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
5905also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
5906unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
5907
5908If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
5909@file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
5910a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
5911have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
5912by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
5913be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
5914the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
5915
5916@smallexample
5917(define_insn ""
5918 [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
5919 (compare:CC_NOOV
5920 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
5921 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
5922 (const_int 0)))]
5923 ""
5924 "@dots{}")
5925@end smallexample
5926
5927@noindent
5928together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
5929for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
5930
5931@smallexample
5932#define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
5933 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
5934 ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode) \
5935 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
5936 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
5937 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
5938@end smallexample
5939
5940Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
5941were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
5942this section.
5943
5944You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
5945in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
5946@end defmac
5947
5948@defmac CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
5949On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
5950convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
5951does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
5952comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
5953
5954On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
5955required conversions. @var{code} is the initial comparison code
5956and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
5957comparison, respectively. You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
5958@var{op1} as required.
5959
5960GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
5961valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
5962@file{md} file.
5963
5964You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
5965code or operands.
5966@end defmac
5967
5968@defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
5969A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
5970comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
5971can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
5972then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
5973
5974You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
5975floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
5976For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
5977inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
5978
5979@smallexample
5980#define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
5981@end smallexample
5982@end defmac
5983
5984@defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
5985A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
5986comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
5987@code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
5988machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
5989instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
5990freely convert unordered compares to ordered one. Then definition may look
5991like:
5992
5993@smallexample
5994#define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
5995 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
5996 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
5997@end smallexample
5998@end defmac
5999
6000@hook TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS
6001On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6002register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6003regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6004hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
6005small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
6006to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6007arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6008When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
6009integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
6010@code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6011
6012The default version of this hook returns false.
6013@end deftypefn
6014
6015@hook TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE
6016On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6017@code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6018validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
6019target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6020both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
6021return @code{VOIDmode}.
6022
6023The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6024same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6025returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6026@end deftypefn
6027
ac7eb5c6 6028@node Cond Exec Macros
38f8b050
JR
6029@subsection Macros to control conditional execution
6030@findex conditional execution
6031@findex predication
6032
6033There is one macro that may need to be defined for targets
6034supporting conditional execution, independent of how they
6035represent conditional branches.
6036
6037@defmac REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (@var{op1}, @var{op2})
6038A C expression that returns true if the conditional execution predicate
6039@var{op1}, a comparison operation, is the inverse of @var{op2} and vice
6040versa. Define this to return 0 if the target has conditional execution
6041predicates that cannot be reversed safely. There is no need to validate
6042that the arguments of op1 and op2 are the same, this is done separately.
6043If no expansion is specified, this macro is defined as follows:
6044
6045@smallexample
6046#define REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (x, y) \
6047 (GET_CODE ((x)) == reversed_comparison_code ((y), NULL))
6048@end smallexample
6049@end defmac
6050
6051@node Costs
6052@section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6053@cindex costs of instructions
6054@cindex relative costs
6055@cindex speed of instructions
6056
6057These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6058on the target machine.
6059
6060@defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6061A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6062register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6063expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6064value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6065that.
6066
6067It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6068same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6069registers if they are not general registers.
6070
6071If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6072hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6073classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6074constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6075allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6076if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6077
6078These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6079@code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6080@end defmac
6081
6082@hook TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST
6083This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6084from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6085are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6086A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6087that.
6088
6089It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6090same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6091registers if they are not general registers.
6092
6093If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6094hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6095classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6096constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6097allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6098if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6099
6100The default version of this function returns 2.
6101@end deftypefn
6102
6103@defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6104A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6105register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6106is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
6107is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6108registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6109should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6110
6111If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6112the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6113needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6114between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6115more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6116reflect the actual cost of the move.
6117
6118GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6119secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6120a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6121secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
61224 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6123value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6124are the same as to this macro.
6125
6126These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6127@code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6128@end defmac
6129
911852ff 6130@hook TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST
38f8b050 6131This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
911852ff 6132between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
38f8b050
JR
6133if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6134This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6135If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6136registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6137
6138If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6139the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6140needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
911852ff 6141between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
38f8b050
JR
6142more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6143reflect the actual cost of the move.
6144
6145GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6146secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6147a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6148secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
61494 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6150value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6151are the same as to this target hook.
6152@end deftypefn
6153
6154@defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
525d13b0
MS
6155A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
6156the default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter
6157@var{speed_p} is true when the branch in question should be optimized
6158for speed. When it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should return a value
6159optimal for code size rather than performance. @var{predictable_p} is
6160true for well-predicted branches. On many architectures the
6161@code{BRANCH_COST} can be reduced then.
38f8b050
JR
6162@end defmac
6163
6164Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6165but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6166ordinarily expect.
6167
6168@defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6169Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6170than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6171faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6172require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6173between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6174
6175When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6176finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6177load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6178faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6179may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6180other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6181@end defmac
6182
6183@defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
6184Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6185@var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6186than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6187handler.
6188
6189When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6190@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
6191moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6192Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
6193cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6194
6195If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
6196this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6197@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
6198@end defmac
6199
6200@defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6201The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6202which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6203string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6204make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6205
6206Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6207@code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6208the number of such sequences.
6209
6210The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6211optimized for speed rather than size.
6212
6213If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6214@end defmac
6215
6216@defmac MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6217A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
6218copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
6219will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6220than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6221@end defmac
6222
6223@defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6224A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6225a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6226@end defmac
6227
6228@defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6229The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6230of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6231or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6232eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6233
6234The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6235optimized for speed rather than size.
6236
6237If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6238@end defmac
6239
6240@defmac CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6241A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
6242to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
6243will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6244than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
6245@end defmac
6246
6247@defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6248The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6249of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
ff2ce160 6250a block set insn or a library call.
38f8b050
JR
6251Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6252eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6253
6254The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6255optimized for speed rather than size.
6256
6257If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6258@end defmac
6259
6260@defmac SET_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6261A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
ff2ce160
MS
6262used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some
6263other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when
38f8b050
JR
6264storing values other than constant zero.
6265Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6266than @code{SET_RATIO}.
6267@end defmac
6268
6269@defmac STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6270A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6271used to set a chunk of memory to a constant string value, or whether some
6272other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
6273called with a constant source string.
6274Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6275than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6276@end defmac
6277
6278@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6279A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6280thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6281@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6282@end defmac
6283
6284@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6285A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6286thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6287@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6288@end defmac
6289
6290@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6291A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6292thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6293@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6294@end defmac
6295
6296@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6297A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6298thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6299@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6300@end defmac
6301
6302@defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6303A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6304thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6305@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6306@end defmac
6307
6308@defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6309A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6310thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6311@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6312@end defmac
6313
6314@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6315This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6316thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6317@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6318@end defmac
6319
6320@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6321This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6322thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6323@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6324@end defmac
6325
6326@defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6327Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
6328function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6329@end defmac
6330
6331@defmac RANGE_TEST_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6332Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6333@samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6334@code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6335@end defmac
6336
6337@hook TARGET_RTX_COSTS
6338This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6339
6340The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
68f932c4
RS
6341available for examination in @var{x}, and the fact that @var{x} appears
6342as operand @var{opno} of an expression with rtx code @var{outer_code}.
6343That is, the hook can assume that there is some rtx @var{y} such
6344that @samp{GET_CODE (@var{y}) == @var{outer_code}} and such that
6345either (a) @samp{XEXP (@var{y}, @var{opno}) == @var{x}} or
6346(b) @samp{XVEC (@var{y}, @var{opno})} contains @var{x}.
6347
6348@var{code} is @var{x}'s expression code---redundant, since it can be
6349obtained with @code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
38f8b050
JR
6350
6351In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6352@code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6353instructions.
6354
6355On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6356for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
6357necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6358for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6359operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6360
6361When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6362false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6363size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6364
6365The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6366processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6367@end deftypefn
6368
6369@hook TARGET_ADDRESS_COST
6370This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6371@var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6372the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6373
6374For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6375true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6376instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6377all addresses will have equal costs.
6378
6379In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6380the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6381cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6382
6383For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6384and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6385is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6386references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6387the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6388that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6389instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6390specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6391
6392This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6393
6394On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6395cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6396@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6397be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6398@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6399should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6400should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6401registers on machines with lots of registers.
6402@end deftypefn
6403
6404@node Scheduling
6405@section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6406
6407The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6408adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6409hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6410them: try the first ones in this list first.
6411
6412@hook TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE
6413This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6414issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6415Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6416an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6417constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6418hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6419This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6420it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
6421@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6422@end deftypefn
6423
6424@hook TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE
6425This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6426from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
6427still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6428@samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6429@code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6430You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6431than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6432@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6433debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6434@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6435was scheduled.
6436@end deftypefn
6437
6438@hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST
6439This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6440relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
6441dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
6442is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
6443to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
6444that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
6445data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6446description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6447output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6448times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6449acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
6450@pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
6451@end deftypefn
6452
6453@hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY
6454This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6455@var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6456execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
6457later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6458scheduling priorities of insns.
6459@end deftypefn
6460
6461@hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER
6462This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6463list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6464combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6465@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6466debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6467@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6468list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6469a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6470reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
6471@var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
6472is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6473the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6474can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6475@samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6476@end deftypefn
6477
6478@hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2
6479Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6480function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6481is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6482@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6483return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6484this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6485scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6486cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6487@end deftypefn
6488
6489@hook TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK
6490This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6491chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6492correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6493example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6494analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6495dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6496calculated.
6497@end deftypefn
6498
6499@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT
6500This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6501instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6502pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6503is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6504@var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6505region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
6506scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
6507@end deftypefn
6508
6509@hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH
6510This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6511instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6512cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6513is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6514to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6515@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6516@end deftypefn
6517
6518@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL
6519This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6520@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6521@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6522@var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6523@end deftypefn
6524
6525@hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL
6526This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
6527@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6528@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6529@end deftypefn
6530
6531@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
6532The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6533pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6534when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6535simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6536processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6537based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6538when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6539@end deftypefn
6540
6541@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
6542The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6543@end deftypefn
6544
6545@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
6546The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6547to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6548simulated processor cycle finishes.
6549@end deftypefn
6550
6551@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
6552The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6553used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6554@end deftypefn
6555
6556@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE
6557The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6558The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6559to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6560state on a single insn is not enough.
6561@end deftypefn
6562
6563@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE
6564The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6565The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6566to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6567state on a single insn is not enough.
6568@end deftypefn
6569
6570@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD
6571This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6572for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6573chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6574value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6575@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6576subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6577maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6578@acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6579packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6580rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6581
6582This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6583processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6584with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6585@var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6586@var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6587processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6588@var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6589until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6590the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6591
6592Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6593pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6594schedules to choose the best one.
6595
6596The default is no multipass scheduling.
6597@end deftypefn
6598
6599@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD
6600
6601This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6602considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
6603zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be not chosen to
6604be issued.
6605
6606The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
6607@end deftypefn
6608
894fd6f2
MK
6609@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN
6610This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
6611scheduling.
6612@end deftypefn
6613
6614@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE
6615This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
6616@end deftypefn
6617
6618@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK
6619This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
6620an instruction.
6621@end deftypefn
6622
6623@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END
6624This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
6625round of multipass scheduling.
6626@end deftypefn
6627
6628@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT
2b0d3573 6629This hook initializes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
894fd6f2
MK
6630@end deftypefn
6631
6632@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI
2b0d3573 6633This hook finalizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
894fd6f2
MK
6634@end deftypefn
6635
c06bbdf7 6636@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE
38f8b050
JR
6637This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6638on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6639@var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6640the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6641is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6642start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6643verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6644@var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6645processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6646and the current processor cycle.
6647@end deftypefn
6648
6649@hook TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE
6650This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
6651the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
6652are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
6653to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6654being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
6655dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
6656parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
6657The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6658insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6659and @code{false} otherwise.
6660
6661Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
6662where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
6663delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
6664that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
6665important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
6666closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
6667not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
6668@end deftypefn
6669
6670@hook TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED
6671This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6672the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6673per instruction data structures.
6674@end deftypefn
6675
6676@hook TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT
6677Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6678@end deftypefn
6679
6680@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT
6681Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6682It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
6683beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
6684@end deftypefn
6685
6686@hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT
6687Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
6688@end deftypefn
6689
6690@hook TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT
6691Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6692@end deftypefn
6693
6694@hook TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT
6695Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6696@end deftypefn
6697
6698@hook TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN
6699This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6700speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6701The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6702version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6703pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
6704or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
6705speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6706the generated speculative pattern.
6707@end deftypefn
6708
6709@hook TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P
6710This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
6711for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6712instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
6713@end deftypefn
6714
6715@hook TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK
6716This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
6717check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6718speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6719@var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6720be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6721recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6722a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
6723@var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6724@end deftypefn
6725
6726@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD_SPEC
6727This hook is used as a workaround for
6728@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD} not being
6729called on the first instruction of the ready list. The hook is used to
6730discard speculative instructions that stand first in the ready list from
6731being scheduled on the current cycle. If the hook returns @code{false},
6732@var{insn} will not be chosen to be issued.
6733For non-speculative instructions,
6734the hook should always return @code{true}. For example, in the ia64 backend
6735the hook is used to cancel data speculative insns when the ALAT table
6736is nearly full.
6737@end deftypefn
6738
6739@hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS
6740This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
6741enabled/used.
6742The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
6743The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6744@end deftypefn
6745
6746@hook TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII
6747This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6748resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6749the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
6750backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
6751bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6752of instructions divided by the issue rate.
6753@end deftypefn
6754
7942e47e
RY
6755@hook TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH
6756This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
6757is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
6758@end deftypefn
6759
6760@hook TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO
6761This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
6762in its second parameter.
6763@end deftypefn
6764
b0bd15f7
BS
6765@hook TARGET_SCHED_EXPOSED_PIPELINE
6766
df7b0cc4
EI
6767@hook TARGET_SCHED_REASSOCIATION_WIDTH
6768
38f8b050
JR
6769@node Sections
6770@section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6771@c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
6772@c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
6773
6774An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6775data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
6776section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
6777section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
6778section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
6779of sections.
6780
6781@file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
6782@code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
6783The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
6784is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
6785as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
6786initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
6787They may however depend on command-line flags.
6788
6789@emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
6790use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
6791to be string literals.
6792
6793Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
6794section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
6795should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
6796@code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
6797
6798You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
6799@code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
6800in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
6801@code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
6802create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
6803reuse @code{text_section}.
6804
6805All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
6806if the target does not provide them.
6807
6808@defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6809A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6810assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
6811Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
6812@end defmac
6813
6814@defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6815If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
6816frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
6817a default definition if the target supports named sections.
6818@end defmac
6819
6820@defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6821If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
6822executed functions in the program.
6823@end defmac
6824
6825@defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6826A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6827assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
6828data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
6829@end defmac
6830
6831@defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6832If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6833containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6834initialized, writable small data.
6835@end defmac
6836
6837@defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6838A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6839assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
6840data.
6841@end defmac
6842
6843@defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6844If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6845containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
07c5f94e
AS
6846uninitialized global data. If not defined, and
6847@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} not defined,
38f8b050
JR
6848uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
6849@option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
6850used.
6851@end defmac
6852
6853@defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6854If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6855containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6856uninitialized, writable small data.
6857@end defmac
6858
6859@defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
6860If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
6861assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
6862common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
6863@end defmac
6864
6865@defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
6866If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
6867containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
6868default is @code{'T'}.
6869@end defmac
6870
6871@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6872If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6873containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6874initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6875not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
6876variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6877@end defmac
6878
6879@defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
6880If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6881containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6882finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6883not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
6884variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6885@end defmac
6886
6887@defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6888If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6889containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6890part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6891defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6892both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6893@end defmac
6894
6895@defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6896If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6897containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6898part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6899defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6900both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6901@end defmac
6902
6903@defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
6904If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
6905via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
6906the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
6907@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
6908to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
6909sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
6910ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
6911registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
6912constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
6913@end defmac
6914
6915@defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
6916If defined, a string which names the section into which small
6917variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
6918when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
6919you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
6920they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
6921expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
6922MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
6923require small data support from your application, but use this macro
6924to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
6925access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
6926@end defmac
6927
6928@defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
6929If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
6930arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
6931@code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
6932and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
6933@end defmac
6934
6935@defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
6936Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
6937tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
6938section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
6939readonly data section is used.
6940
6941This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
6942@end defmac
6943
6944@hook TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS
6945Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
6946@file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
6947of its own that you need to create.
6948
6949GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
6950any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
6951described below.
6952@end deftypefn
6953
6954@hook TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK
6955Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
6956selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
6957should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
6958local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
6959
6960The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
6961is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
6962when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
6963in read-only sections even in executables.
6964@end deftypefn
6965
6966@hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION
6967Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
6968assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
6969some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
6970requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
6971local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
6972@var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
6973
6974The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
6975variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
6976
6977See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
6978@end deftypefn
6979
6980@defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
6981Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
6982for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
6983
6984In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
6985function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
6986it is unlikely to be called.
6987@end defmac
6988
6989@hook TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION
6990Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
6991and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
6992As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
6993the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
6994
6995The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
6996ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
6997example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
6998Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
6999@end deftypefn
7000
7001@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION
7002Return the readonly data section associated with
7003@samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7004The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7005the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7006if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7007otherwise.
7008@end deftypefn
7009
727a65e6
BS
7010@hook TARGET_ASM_MERGEABLE_RODATA_PREFIX
7011
38f8b050
JR
7012@hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION
7013Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7014should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
7015constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
7016case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
7017in bits.
7018
7019The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7020constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7021else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7022@end deftypefn
7023
7024@hook TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME
7025Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7026by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7027the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7028or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
7029hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7030your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
7031returns the @var{id} provided.
7032@end deftypefn
7033
7034@hook TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO
7035Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7036treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7037function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7038
7039The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7040@var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7041an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7042rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7043in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7044
7045In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7046a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7047will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7048register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7049rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7050leave it alone.)
7051
7052The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7053that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
7054be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7055declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7056declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7057@var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7058
7059@cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7060The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7061@code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7062Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7063encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7064discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7065
7066The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7067in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7068@code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7069before overriding it.
7070@end deftypefn
7071
7072@hook TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING
7073Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7074the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7075may have added.
7076@end deftypefn
7077
7078@hook TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P
7079Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7080The default version of this hook always returns false.
7081@end deftypefn
7082
7083@hook TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7084Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7085``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
7086@end deftypevr
7087
3c5273a9
KT
7088@hook TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
7089
38f8b050
JR
7090@hook TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P
7091Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7092rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7093or executable image).
7094
7095The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7096for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7097currently supported object file formats.
7098@end deftypefn
7099
7100@hook TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7101Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7102The default value is false.
7103@end deftypevr
7104
7105
7106@node PIC
7107@section Position Independent Code
7108@cindex position independent code
7109@cindex PIC
7110
7111This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7112independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7113generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7114@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7115@code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7116must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7117when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7118need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7119relative addresses.
ff2ce160 7120@c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
38f8b050
JR
7121@c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7122
7123@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7124The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7125data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
7126processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
7127is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7128pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7129is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7130necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7131when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7132@end defmac
7133
7134@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
f8fe0a4a
JM
7135A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7136@code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7137the default is zero. Do not define
38f8b050
JR
7138this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7139@end defmac
7140
7141@defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7142A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7143operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7144You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7145check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7146check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7147(including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7148position independent code.
7149@end defmac
7150
7151@node Assembler Format
7152@section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7153
7154This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7155to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7156instructions do.
7157
7158@menu
7159* File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7160* Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7161* Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7162* Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7163* Initialization:: General principles of initialization
7164 and termination routines.
7165* Macros for Initialization::
7166 Specific macros that control the handling of
7167 initialization and termination routines.
7168* Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7169* Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7170* Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7171* Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7172@end menu
7173
7174@node File Framework
7175@subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7176@cindex assembler format
7177@cindex output of assembler code
7178
7179@c prevent bad page break with this line
7180This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7181
7182@findex default_file_start
7183@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START
7184Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7185find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7186by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7187quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7188@code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7189lets other target files rely on these variables.
7190@end deftypefn
7191
7192@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7193If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7194printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7195@option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7196to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7197definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7198assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7199whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7200
7201The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7202verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7203comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7204@end deftypevr
7205
7206@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7207If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7208for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7209@code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7210this to be done. The default is false.
7211@end deftypevr
7212
7213@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_END
7214Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7215to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7216@end deftypefn
7217
7218@deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7219Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7220special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7221the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7222should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7223need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7224this function.
7225@end deftypefun
7226
7227@hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_START
7228Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7229to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7230nothing.
7231@end deftypefn
7232
7233@hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_END
7234Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7235to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7236nothing.
7237@end deftypefn
7238
7239@hook TARGET_ASM_CODE_END
7240Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7241unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7242here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7243because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7244nothing.
7245@end deftypefn
7246
7247@defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7248A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7249assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7250the end of the line.
7251@end defmac
7252
7253@defmac ASM_APP_ON
7254A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7255statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7256@code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7257assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7258that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7259@end defmac
7260
7261@defmac ASM_APP_OFF
7262A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7263statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7264@code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7265time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7266@end defmac
7267
7268@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7269A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7270which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7271the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7272
7273This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7274for the file format in use is appropriate.
7275@end defmac
7276
b5f5d41d
AS
7277@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
7278
38f8b050
JR
7279@defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7280A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7281@var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
7282in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
7283the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7284of the filename using this macro.
7285@end defmac
7286
7287@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7288A C statement to output something to the assembler file to handle a
7289@samp{#ident} directive containing the text @var{string}. If this
7290macro is not defined, nothing is output for a @samp{#ident} directive.
7291@end defmac
7292
7293@hook TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION
7294Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7295should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
7296of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7297is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7298this section is associated.
7299@end deftypefn
7300
f16d3f39
JH
7301@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION
7302Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.
7303Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
ff2ce160 7304functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only
f16d3f39
JH
7305at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).
7306@var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit
7307(from static destructors).
7308Return NULL if function should go to default text section.
7309@end deftypefn
7310
14d11d40
IS
7311@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SWITCHED_TEXT_SECTIONS
7312
38f8b050
JR
7313@hook TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7314This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
d5fabb58 7315It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
38f8b050
JR
7316@end deftypevr
7317
7318@anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
7319@hook TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
7320This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7321section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7322This is true on most ELF targets.
7323@end deftypevr
7324
7325@hook TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS
7326Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7327based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7328declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
7329null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7330
7331The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7332read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7333need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7334set via @code{__attribute__}.
7335@end deftypefn
7336
7337@hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES
7338Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7339switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7340enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7341It can take the following values:
7342
7343@table @gcctabopt
7344@item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7345@var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7346
7347@item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7348@var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7349direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7350default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7351command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7352various different individual optimization passes.
7353
7354@item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7355@var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7356ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7357target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7358time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7359warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7360wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7361necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7362perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7363switches.
7364
7365@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7366This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7367
7368@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7369This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7370@end table
7371
7372The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7373supported in the future.
7374
7375By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7376provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7377it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7378section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7379provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7380hook.
7381@end deftypefn
7382
7383@hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
7384This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7385ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7386hook.
7387@end deftypevr
7388
7389@need 2000
7390@node Data Output
7391@subsection Output of Data
7392
7393
7394@hook TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7395@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7396@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7397@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7398@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7399@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7400@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7401@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7402@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7403These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7404of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7405byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7406aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7407@code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7408
7409The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7410followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7411the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7412@end deftypevr
7413
7414@hook TARGET_ASM_INTEGER
7415The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7416integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7417in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7418function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7419object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7420split the object into smaller parts.
7421
7422The default implementation of this hook will use the
7423@code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7424when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7425@end deftypefn
7426
6cbd8875
AS
7427@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA
7428A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7429can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7430the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7431@code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7432
7433If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7434so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7435itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7436return @code{true}.
7437@end deftypefn
7438
38f8b050
JR
7439@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
7440A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7441instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7442bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7443@code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7444
7445If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7446Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7447@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
7448@end defmac
7449
7450@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
7451A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7452@var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7453is defined, and is otherwise unused.
7454@end defmac
7455
7456@defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
7457You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
7458expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
7459pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
7460GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7461not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
7462pool before the function.
7463@end defmac
7464
7465@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
7466A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7467constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7468the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7469be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7470is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7471immediately after this call.
7472
7473If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7474not be defined.
7475@end defmac
7476
7477@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
7478A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7479constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7480anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7481
7482The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7483assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7484output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7485@samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7486@var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7487alignment.
7488
7489The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7490the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7491responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7492Here is how to do this:
7493
7494@smallexample
7495@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
7496@end smallexample
7497
7498When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7499@code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7500entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7501
7502You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
7503@end defmac
7504
7505@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
7506A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7507pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7508function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7509obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
7510constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
7511
7512If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7513define this macro.
7514@end defmac
7515
7516@defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
7517Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
7518used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7519to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7520a line separator uses multiple characters.
7521
7522If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7523the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
7524@end defmac
7525
7526@hook TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
7527These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7528assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7529default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
7530@end deftypevr
7531
7532These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
7533of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7534
7535@defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7536@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7537@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7538@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7539@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7540@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7541These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7542target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7543the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7544@code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7545simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7546@code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7547by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7548it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
754932 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7550on the host machine.
7551
7552The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7553using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7554machine's memory.
7555@end defmac
7556
7557@node Uninitialized Data
7558@subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7559
7560Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7561outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7562
7563@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7564A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7565@var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7566@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7567is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7568possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7569other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7570backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7571byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7572equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7573the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7574an ordinary undefined external.
7575
7576Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7577output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7578assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7579
7580This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7581common global variables are output.
7582@end defmac
7583
7584@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7585Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7586separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7587place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7588handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7589as the number of bits.
7590@end defmac
7591
7592@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7593Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7594variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7595is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7596in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7597@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
7598the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7599@end defmac
7600
07c5f94e 7601@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
38f8b050
JR
7602A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7603@var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
07c5f94e
AS
7604@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{alignment}
7605is the alignment specified as the number of bits.
38f8b050 7606
07c5f94e
AS
7607Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7608@file{varasm.c} when defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
38f8b050
JR
7609@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7610before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7611the name, and a newline.
7612
07c5f94e 7613There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define this macro.
38f8b050
JR
7614The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7615switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7616You do not need to do both.
7617
7618Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7619non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7620efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
7621not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7622common in order to save space in the object file.
7623@end defmac
7624
38f8b050
JR
7625@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7626A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7627@var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7628@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7629is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7630
7631Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7632output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7633assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7634
7635This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7636static variables are output.
7637@end defmac
7638
7639@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7640Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
7641separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7642place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
7643handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7644as the number of bits.
7645@end defmac
7646
7647@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7648Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
7649variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7650is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7651in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
7652@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
7653the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7654@end defmac
7655
7656@node Label Output
7657@subsection Output and Generation of Labels
7658
7659@c prevent bad page break with this line
7660This is about outputting labels.
7661
7662@findex assemble_name
7663@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7664A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7665@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
7666Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7667output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7668assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7669definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7670@end defmac
7671
135a687e
KT
7672@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7673A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7674@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
7675a function.
7676Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7677output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7678assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7679definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7680
7681If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7682usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7683@end defmac
7684
38f8b050
JR
7685@findex assemble_name_raw
7686@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7687Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
7688to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
7689@code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
7690that it is more efficient.
7691@end defmac
7692
7693@defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
7694A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7695size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7696default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
7697systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7698
7699Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
7700of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
7701for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
7702macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
7703define this macro.
7704@end defmac
7705
7706@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
7707A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7708@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
7709symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
7710If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7711provided.
7712@end defmac
7713
7714@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7715A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7716@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
7717the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
7718address.
7719
7720If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7721provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
7722@samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
7723the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
7724not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
7725to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
7726@end defmac
7727
7728@defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
7729A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7730type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7731default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
7732systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7733
7734Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7735@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7736custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7737types at all, do not define this macro.
7738@end defmac
7739
7740@defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
7741A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
7742the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
7743default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
7744the default is not to define this macro.
7745
7746Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7747@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7748custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7749types at all, do not define this macro.
7750@end defmac
7751
7752@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7753A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7754@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
7755symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
7756that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
7757you should not count on this.
7758
7759If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
7760definition of this macro is provided.
7761@end defmac
7762
7763@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7764A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7765@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7766function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
7767outputting the label definition (perhaps using
135a687e 7768@code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
38f8b050
JR
7769@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7770
7771If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
135a687e 7772usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
38f8b050
JR
7773
7774You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
7775of this macro.
7776@end defmac
7777
7778@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7779A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7780@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
7781which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
7782function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
7783representing the function.
7784
7785If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
7786
7787You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
7788of this macro.
7789@end defmac
7790
7791@defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7792A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7793@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
7794initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
7795label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
7796@var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
7797
7798If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
7799usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7800
7801You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7802@code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
7803@end defmac
7804
ad78130c 7805@hook TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME
38f8b050
JR
7806A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
7807for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
7808target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7809@code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
7810and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
7811will be an internal label.
7812
7813The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
7814usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
7815
7816You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
7817@end deftypefn
7818
7819@defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
7820A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7821@var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
7822for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
7823
7824If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7825nothing.
7826@end defmac
7827
7828@defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
7829A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
7830once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
7831chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
7832initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
7833something about the size of the object.
7834
7835If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7836nothing.
7837
7838You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7839@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
7840@end defmac
7841
7842@hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL
7843This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7844@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
7845that is, available for reference from other files.
7846
7847The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
7848@code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
7849@end deftypefn
7850
7851@hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME
7852This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7853@var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
7854global; that is, available for reference from other files.
7855
7856The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
7857@end deftypefn
7858
7859@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7860A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7861@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
7862that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
7863no other definition is available. Use the expression
7864@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
7865itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
7866for making that name weak, and a newline.
7867
7868If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
7869support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
7870macro.
7871@end defmac
7872
7873@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7874Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
7875@code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
7876or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
7877should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
7878defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
7879@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
7880to make @var{name} weak.
7881@end defmac
7882
7883@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7884Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
7885symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
7886declaration of @code{name}.
7887@end defmac
7888
7889@defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
74b90fe2
JDA
7890A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
7891supports weak symbols.
38f8b050
JR
7892
7893If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7894definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
74b90fe2
JDA
7895is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
7896@end defmac
7897
7898@defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
7899A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
7900
7901If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7902definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
7903this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
7904flag such as @option{-melf}.
38f8b050
JR
7905@end defmac
7906
7907@defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
7908A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
7909public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
7910be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
7911format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
7912section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
7913requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
7914@end defmac
7915
7916@defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
7917A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
7918semantics.
7919
7920If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
7921definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
7922definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
7923you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
7924setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
7925be emitted as one-only.
7926@end defmac
7927
7928@hook TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY
7929This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
7930commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
7931hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
7932@end deftypefn
7933
7934@defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
7935A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
7936that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
7937The default is @code{0}.
7938
7939Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
7940if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
7941will have undefined references from other translation units, that
7942symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
7943thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
7944(explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
7945with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
7946
7947The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
7948targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
7949restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
7950table of contents.
7951@end defmac
7952
7953@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
7954A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7955@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
7956symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
7957not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
7958declaration.
7959
7960This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
7961The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
7962@end defmac
7963
7964@hook TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL
7965This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
7966pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
7967library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
7968@end deftypefn
7969
7970@hook TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED
7971This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
7972directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
7973.no_dead_code_strip directive.
7974@end deftypefn
7975
7976@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7977A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7978@var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
7979@var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
7980is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
7981systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
7982@end defmac
7983
77754180
DK
7984@hook TARGET_MANGLE_ASSEMBLER_NAME
7985
38f8b050
JR
7986@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
7987A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
7988@code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
7989will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
7990to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
7991encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
7992@end defmac
7993
7994@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
7995A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
7996result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
7997@code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
7998This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
7999specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
8000when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
8001being taken.
8002@end defmac
8003
8004@hook TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL
8005A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8006name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
8007
8008It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8009used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
8010will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8011
8012It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8013object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8014should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8015beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
8016convention your system uses, and follow it.
8017
8018The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
8019@end deftypefn
8020
8021@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8022A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8023label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8024@var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8025may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8026systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8027bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8028bundles.
8029
8030If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8031used.
8032@end defmac
8033
8034@defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8035A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8036is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8037
8038This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8039produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8040with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8041
8042If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8043output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8044@code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8045string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8046to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8047@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8048you should know what it does on your machine.)
8049@end defmac
8050
8051@defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8052A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8053@code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8054@var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8055added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8056
8057The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8058produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8059@var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8060assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8061macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8062internal static variables in different scopes.
8063
8064Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8065conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8066or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8067between the name and the number will suffice.
8068
8069If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8070which is correct for most systems.
8071@end defmac
8072
8073@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8074A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8075which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8076
8077@findex SET_ASM_OP
8078If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8079correct for most systems.
8080@end defmac
8081
8082@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8083A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8084which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8085to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8086be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8087the tree nodes are available.
8088
8089@findex SET_ASM_OP
8090If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8091correct for most systems.
8092@end defmac
8093
8094@defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8095A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8096(equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8097of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8098current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8099This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8100@samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8101@end defmac
8102
8103@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8104A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8105which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8106@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8107an undefined weak symbol.
8108
8109Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8110@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8111@end defmac
8112
8113@defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8114Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8115Objective-C methods.
8116
8117The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8118class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8119the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8120@samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8121
8122These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8123the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8124systems define other ways of computing names.
8125
8126@var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8127buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8128@var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
812950 characters extra.
8130
8131The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8132method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8133@var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8134in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8135
8136On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8137macro to provide more human-readable names.
8138@end defmac
8139
8140@defmac ASM_DECLARE_CLASS_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8141A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8142@var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8143Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets whose
8144linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8145@end defmac
8146
8147@defmac ASM_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8148A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8149@var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8150unresolved Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets
8151whose linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8152@end defmac
8153
8154@node Initialization
8155@subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8156@cindex initialization routines
8157@cindex termination routines
8158@cindex constructors, output of
8159@cindex destructors, output of
8160
8161The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8162(also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8163data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8164to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8165@code{main} is called.
8166
8167Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8168@dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8169terminates.
8170
8171To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8172must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8173be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8174system, you need to specify how to do this.
8175
8176There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8177initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8178Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8179
8180@findex __CTOR_LIST__
8181@findex __DTOR_LIST__
8182The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8183initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8184termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8185
8186Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
81870, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8188the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8189pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8190pointer containing zero.
8191
8192Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8193@file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8194time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8195list; destructors in forward order.
8196
8197The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8198formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8199aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8200Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8201object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8202the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8203accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8204Termination functions are handled similarly.
8205
8206This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8207@code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
8208support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8209constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8210and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8211
8212When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8213upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
8214support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8215parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
8216program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8217
8218@smallexample
8219ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8220@end smallexample
8221
8222The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8223section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8224for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8225files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8226are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8227
8228The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8229compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8230fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8231to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8232of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8233that invokes the routines we need at startup.
8234
8235To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8236macro properly.
8237
8238If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8239@code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8240entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8241it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8242after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8243in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
8244
8245In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8246two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8247and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
8248@code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
8249entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8250and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8251code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
8252the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
8253placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8254a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
8255@code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
8256section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8257the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8258the initialization process.
8259
8260The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8261This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
8262file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
8263this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8264termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8265an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8266pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8267the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8268initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8269via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8270@code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
8271
8272@ifinfo
8273The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8274customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8275@end ifinfo
8276
8277@node Macros for Initialization
8278@subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8279
8280Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8281and termination functions:
8282
8283@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
8284If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8285operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8286defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8287using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8288macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8289run the initialization functions.
8290@end defmac
8291
8292@defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
8293If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
8294This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8295on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8296be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
8297@end defmac
8298
8299@defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
8300If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8301the following symbol is an initialization routine.
8302@end defmac
8303
8304@defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
8305If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8306the following symbol is a finalization routine.
8307@end defmac
8308
8309@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8310If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8311automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8312should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8313the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
8314function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
8315
8316This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
8317shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
8318exception tables embedded in the code.
8319@end defmac
8320
8321@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8322If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8323automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8324should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8325the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
8326function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
8327@end defmac
8328
8329@defmac INVOKE__main
8330If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8331@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8332where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8333useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
8334@end defmac
8335
8336@defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
8337If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8338compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8339of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8340encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
8341@end defmac
8342
8343@hook TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
8344This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8345collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8346It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
8347@end deftypevr
8348
8349@hook TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR
8350If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8351the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
8352
8353Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8354no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8355priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8356otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8357
8358If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
8359be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8360target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8361is not defined.
8362@end deftypefn
8363
8364@hook TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR
8365This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
8366functions rather than initialization functions.
8367@end deftypefn
8368
8369If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8370generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
8371
8372If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8373constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8374an object file for constructor functions to be called.
8375
8376On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
8377@command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
8378
8379@defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
8380Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
8381object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
8382object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
8383
8384This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
8385part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
8386@end defmac
8387
8388@defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
8389Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
8390to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8391@command{nm}.
3e794bfe
RO
8392@end defmac
8393
8394@defmac NM_FLAGS
8395@command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
8396constructors and destructors and LTO info. By default, @option{-n} is
8397passed. Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
2b0d3573 8398are needed to get the same output format as GNU @command{nm -n}
3e794bfe
RO
8399produces.
8400@end defmac
38f8b050
JR
8401
8402If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8403dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8404these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8405termination functions in shared libraries:
38f8b050
JR
8406
8407@defmac LDD_SUFFIX
8408Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
3e794bfe 8409which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
38f8b050
JR
8410@end defmac
8411
8412@defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
8413Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
8414of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
8415of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8416from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
8417code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8418line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
8419@end defmac
8420
8421@defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8422Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8423library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8424strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8425constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8426that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8427@end defmac
8428
8429@node Instruction Output
8430@subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8431
8432@c prevent bad page break with this line
8433This describes assembler instruction output.
8434
8435@defmac REGISTER_NAMES
8436A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8437registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8438register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
8439@end defmac
8440
8441@defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8442If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8443and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8444registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8445to registers using alternate names.
8446@end defmac
8447
0c6d290e
RE
8448@defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
8449If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
8450name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
8451machine registers the name overlaps. This macro defines additional
8452names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
8453declarations to refer to registers using alternate names. Unlike
8454@code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
8455register name implies multiple underlying registers.
8456
8457This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
8458@code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
8459register name. For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
8460VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
8461``s0'' and ``s1''.
8462@end defmac
8463
38f8b050
JR
8464@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
8465Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8466requires different names for the machine instructions.
8467
8468The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8469assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8470macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8471points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8472written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8473opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8474increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8475so that it will not be output twice.
8476
8477In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8478name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8479that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8480care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8481@var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8482
8483@findex recog_data.operand
8484If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
8485elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
8486
8487If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8488in the usual way.
8489@end defmac
8490
8491@defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
8492If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8493assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8494they will be output differently.
8495
8496Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8497extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8498elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8499The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8500template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8501by changing the contents of the vector.
8502
8503This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8504file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8505can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8506as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8507syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8508writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8509
8510If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
8511@end defmac
8512
8513@hook TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN
8514If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8515output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8516if necessary.
8517
8518Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8519extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8520elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8521The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8522template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8523by checking the contents of the vector.
8524@end deftypefn
8525
8526@defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
8527A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8528assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8529RTL expression.
8530
8531@var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8532of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8533printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8534the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8535operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8536@var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8537@var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8538
8539@findex reg_names
8540If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8541The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8542@code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8543@code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8544
8545When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8546(a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8547with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8548@var{code}.
8549@end defmac
8550
8551@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
8552A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8553punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
8554@code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8555punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8556in this way.
8557@end defmac
8558
8559@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
8560A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8561assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8562whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8563
8564@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
8565On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
8566section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
8567@code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
8568@code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
8569Format}.
8570@end defmac
8571
8572@findex dbr_sequence_length
8573@defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
8574A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8575been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8576determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8577currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8578or whatever.
8579
8580Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8581reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
8582explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
8583@end defmac
8584
8585@findex final_sequence
8586Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
8587prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8588(i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
8589found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8590processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8591being output.
8592
8593@findex asm_fprintf
8594@defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
8595@defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
8596@defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
8597@defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
8598If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
8599@samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
8600@file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
8601support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
8602files can define these macros differently.
8603@end defmac
8604
8605@defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
8606If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
8607statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
8608the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
8609printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
8610statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
8611generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
8612specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
8613The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
8614string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
8615upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
8616@end defmac
8617
8618@defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
8619If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
8620different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
8621numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
8622first variant.
8623
8624If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
8625@smallexample
8626@samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
8627@end smallexample
8628@noindent
8629in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
8630first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
8631@samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
8632@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
8633within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
8634alternatives within the braces than the value of
8635@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
8636
8637If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
8638@samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
8639operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
8640
8641Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
8642@code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
8643the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
8644@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
8645if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
8646opcodes or operand order.
8647@end defmac
8648
8649@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8650A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8651which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
8652The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8653profiling.
8654@end defmac
8655
8656@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8657A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8658which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
8659The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8660profiling.
8661@end defmac
8662
8663@node Dispatch Tables
8664@subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
8665
8666@c prevent bad page break with this line
8667This concerns dispatch tables.
8668
8669@cindex dispatch table
8670@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
8671A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8672pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
8673@var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
8674definitions of these labels are output using
8675@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
8676way here. For example,
8677
8678@smallexample
8679fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
8680 @var{value}, @var{rel})
8681@end smallexample
8682
8683You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
8684dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
8685will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
8686@var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
8687mode and flags can be read.
8688@end defmac
8689
8690@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
8691This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
8692in a dispatch table are absolute.
8693
8694The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
8695@var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
8696a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
8697definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8698For example,
8699
8700@smallexample
8701fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
8702@end smallexample
8703@end defmac
8704
8705@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8706Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
8707specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
8708@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
8709jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
8710@code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
8711
8712This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
8713for the table.
8714
8715If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
8716@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8717@end defmac
8718
8719@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8720Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
8721jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
8722after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
8723the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
8724@var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
8725of the preceding label.
8726
8727If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
8728the jump-table.
8729@end defmac
8730
8731@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL
8732This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
8733should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
8734should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
8735function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
8736The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
8737exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
8738true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
8739
8740The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
8741@end deftypefn
8742
8743@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL
8744This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
8745It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
8746to be broken up according to function.
8747
8748The default is that no label is emitted.
8749@end deftypefn
8750
a68b5e52
RH
8751@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY
8752
38f8b050
JR
8753@hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT
8754This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
f0a0390e
RH
8755given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
8756returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
38f8b050
JR
8757@end deftypefn
8758
3bc6b3e6
RH
8759@hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
8760
38f8b050
JR
8761@node Exception Region Output
8762@subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
8763
8764@c prevent bad page break with this line
8765
8766This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
8767region.
8768
8769@defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
8770If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
8771exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
8772provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
8773@file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
8774
8775You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
8776unwind information and the default definition does not work.
8777@end defmac
8778
8779@defmac EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
8780If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
8781data section even though the target supports named sections. This
8782might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
8783collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
8784
8785Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
8786also defined.
8787@end defmac
8788
8789@defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
8790Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
8791information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
8792runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
8793and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
8794@end defmac
8795
8796@defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
8797An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
8798that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
8799@end defmac
8800
8801@defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
8802Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8803information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
8804Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
f0a0390e
RH
8805@code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either @code{UNALIGNED_INT_ASM_OP}
8806or @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}), GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
8807@end defmac
38f8b050 8808
f0a0390e
RH
8809@hook TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO
8810This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
8811by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
8812should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
8813@code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
8814should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8815information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
38f8b050 8816
f0a0390e
RH
8817A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
8818This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
8819default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
38f8b050 8820
f0a0390e 8821Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
d5fabb58
JM
8822not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
8823@var{opts}. In particular, the
f0a0390e
RH
8824setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
8825macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
8826depending on this setting.
8827
8828The default implementation of the hook first honors the
8829@option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
d5fabb58
JM
8830@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}. If
8831@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
8832must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
f0a0390e 8833@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8834
8835@hook TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
8836This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
d5fabb58
JM
8837tables even when exceptions are not used. It must not be modified by
8838command-line option processing.
38f8b050
JR
8839@end deftypevr
8840
38f8b050
JR
8841@defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
8842Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
8843should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
8844instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
8845@end defmac
8846
8847@defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
8848This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
8849function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
8850@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
8851alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
8852minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
8853the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
8854@end defmac
8855
8856@hook TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
8857Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
8858end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
8859Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
8860true otherwise.
8861@end deftypevr
8862
8863@hook TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN
8864Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
8865represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
8866register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
8867locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
8868register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8869If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8870@end deftypefn
8871
8872@hook TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA
8873If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
8874multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
8875sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
8876It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
8877filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
8878@var{address} is the address of the table.
8879@end deftypefn
8880
8881@hook TARGET_ASM_TTYPE
8882This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
8883the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
8884if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
8885reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
8886@end deftypefn
8887
8888@hook TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
8889This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
8890based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
8891the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
8892running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
8893@end deftypevr
8894
8895@node Alignment Output
8896@subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
8897
8898@c prevent bad page break with this line
8899This describes commands for alignment.
8900
8901@defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8902The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
8903a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
8904
8905This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8906to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8907define the macro.
8908
8909Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8910to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
8911@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8912selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
8913@end defmac
8914
ad0c4c36
DD
8915@hook TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8916The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
8917@code{JUMP_ALIGN}. This works only if
8918@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8919@end deftypefn
8920
38f8b050
JR
8921@defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
8922The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8923a @code{BARRIER}.
8924
8925This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8926to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8927define the macro.
8928@end defmac
8929
ad0c4c36
DD
8930@hook TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
8931The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
38f8b050
JR
8932@code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
8933@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
ad0c4c36 8934@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8935
8936@defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8937The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8938a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
8939
8940This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8941to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8942define the macro.
8943
8944Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8945to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
8946@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8947selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
8948@end defmac
8949
ad0c4c36
DD
8950@hook TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8951The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
8952@var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
8953defined.
8954@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8955
8956@defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
8957The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
8958If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
8959the maximum of the specified values is used.
8960
8961Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8962to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
8963@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8964selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
8965@end defmac
8966
ad0c4c36
DD
8967@hook TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8968The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
8969to @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
8970is defined.
8971@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8972
8973@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
8974A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8975instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
8976Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
8977expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
8978@end defmac
8979
8980@defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
8981Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
8982text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
8983This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
8984produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
8985section.
8986@end defmac
8987
8988@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
8989A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8990command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
8991@var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
8992@end defmac
8993
8994@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
8995Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
8996for padding, if necessary.
8997@end defmac
8998
8999@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
9000A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9001command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9002@var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
9003satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
9004a C expression of type @code{int}.
9005@end defmac
9006
9007@need 3000
9008@node Debugging Info
9009@section Controlling Debugging Information Format
9010
9011@c prevent bad page break with this line
9012This describes how to specify debugging information.
9013
9014@menu
9015* All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9016* DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9017* DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9018* File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9019* SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
9020* VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
9021@end menu
9022
9023@node All Debuggers
9024@subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9025
9026@c prevent bad page break with this line
9027These macros affect all debugging formats.
9028
9029@defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
9030A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
9031register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9032of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9033some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9034versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9035compiler and another for DBX@.
9036
9037If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9038used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9039consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9040Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9041expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9042
9043If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9044does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9045redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9046@end defmac
9047
9048@defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9049A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9050variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9051computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9052gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9053that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9054for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
9055@option{-g} options is used.
9056@end defmac
9057
9058@defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9059A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9060having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9061@var{offset}.
9062@end defmac
9063
9064@defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9065A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9066produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
9067this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9068debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9069@code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9070@code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9071
9072When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9073value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9074exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9075value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9076defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9077
9078The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9079user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9080@option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9081@end defmac
9082
9083@node DBX Options
9084@subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9085
9086@c prevent bad page break with this line
9087These are specific options for DBX output.
9088
9089@defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9090Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9091in response to the @option{-g} option.
9092@end defmac
9093
9094@defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9095Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9096in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
9097@end defmac
9098
9099@defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9100Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9101GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9102debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9103macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9104if there is any occasion to.
9105@end defmac
9106
9107@defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9108Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9109in the text section.
9110@end defmac
9111
9112@defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9113A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9114use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9115If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9116applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9117@end defmac
9118
9119@defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9120A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9121use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9122value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9123@code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9124information format.
9125@end defmac
9126
9127@defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9128A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9129use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9130name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9131macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9132@end defmac
9133
9134@defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9135Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9136@samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9137describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9138On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9139@end defmac
9140
9141@defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9142A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9143continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9144exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9145operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9146must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9147with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9148defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9149@end defmac
9150
9151@defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9152Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9153the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9154a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9155constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9156if backslash is correct for your system.
9157@end defmac
9158
9159@defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9160Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9161outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9162variable.
9163@end defmac
9164
9165@defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9166The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9167for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9168@end defmac
9169
9170@defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9171The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9172for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9173provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9174@end defmac
9175
9176@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9177The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9178for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9179``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9180@end defmac
9181
9182@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9183The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9184passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9185do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
9186@end defmac
9187
9188@defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9189Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9190arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9191in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9192code.
9193@end defmac
9194
9195@defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9196Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9197the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9198relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9199an absolute address.
9200@end defmac
9201
9202@defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9203Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9204the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9205start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9206@end defmac
9207
9208@defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9209Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9210@code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
9211macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9212number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
9213generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9214number for a type number.
9215@end defmac
9216
9217@node DBX Hooks
9218@subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9219
9220@c prevent bad page break with this line
9221These are hooks for DBX format.
9222
9223@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9224Define this macro to say how to output to @var{stream} the debugging
9225information for the start of a scope level for variable names. The
9226argument @var{name} is the name of an assembler symbol (for use with
9227@code{assemble_name}) whose value is the address where the scope begins.
9228@end defmac
9229
9230@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9231Like @code{DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC}, but for the end of a scope level.
9232@end defmac
9233
9234@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NFUN (@var{stream}, @var{lscope_label}, @var{decl})
9235Define this macro if the target machine requires special handling to
9236output an @code{N_FUN} entry for the function @var{decl}.
9237@end defmac
9238
9239@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9240A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9241number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9242@var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
9243invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9244unique labels in the assembly output.
9245
9246This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9247if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9248@end defmac
9249
9250@defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
9251Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
9252@code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
9253On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9254disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9255@end defmac
9256
9257@defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9258Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9259extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9260feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9261@end defmac
9262
9263@node File Names and DBX
9264@subsection File Names in DBX Format
9265
9266@c prevent bad page break with this line
9267This describes file names in DBX format.
9268
9269@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9270A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
9271@var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
9272file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9273This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9274
9275This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9276for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
9277
9278It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9279text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9280to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9281@var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
9282@end defmac
9283
9284@defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9285Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9286of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9287the beginning of the file.
9288@end defmac
9289
9290@defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9291Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9292that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9293an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9294@samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
9295@end defmac
9296
9297@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9298A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
9299compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9300written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9301
9302If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9303of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
9304@end defmac
9305
9306@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9307Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9308@code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
9309the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
9310whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9311@end defmac
9312
9313@need 2000
9314@node SDB and DWARF
9315@subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9316
9317@c prevent bad page break with this line
9318Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9319
9320@defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
9321Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
9322for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
9323@end defmac
9324
9325@defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
9326Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
9327debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
9328
9329@hook TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION
9330Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9331be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9332value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9333@end deftypefn
9334
9335To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9336define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9337@code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9338prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
9339as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
9340@end defmac
9341
9342@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
9343Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
f0a0390e
RH
9344Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9345(@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9346exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9347how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
38f8b050
JR
9348@end defmac
9349
f0a0390e
RH
9350@hook TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO
9351This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9352unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9353@code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9354return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9355
9356A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9357is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9358
9359A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9360This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9361@end deftypefn
9362
38f8b050
JR
9363@defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
9364Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9365line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9366tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
9367@end defmac
9368
9730bc27
TT
9369@hook TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9370
2ba42841
AO
9371@hook TARGET_DELAY_SCHED2
9372
9373@hook TARGET_DELAY_VARTRACK
9374
38f8b050
JR
9375@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9376A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9377@var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9378@end defmac
9379
9380@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9381A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9382between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9383slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9384@end defmac
9385
9386@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
9387A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
9388section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
9389given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
9390@end defmac
9391
9392@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9393A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
9394reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9395@end defmac
9396
9397@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9398A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9399the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9400is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9401is referenced by a function.
9402@end defmac
9403
9404@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL
9405If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9406reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9407@end deftypefn
9408
9409@defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
9410Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9411SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9412macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9413not define them yourself.
9414@end defmac
9415
9416@defmac SDB_DELIM
9417Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9418SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9419delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9420a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9421required.
9422@end defmac
9423
9424@defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
9425Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9426union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9427allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9428it.
9429@end defmac
9430
9431@defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
9432Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9433enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9434assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
9435@end defmac
9436
9437@defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9438A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9439number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9440@var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9441@end defmac
9442
9443@need 2000
9444@node VMS Debug
9445@subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9446
9447@c prevent bad page break with this line
9448Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9449
9450@defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9451Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9452in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9453is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9454@option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
fac0f722 9455behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
38f8b050
JR
9456@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
9457@end defmac
9458
9459@node Floating Point
9460@section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9461@cindex cross compilation and floating point
9462@cindex floating point and cross compilation
9463
9464While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
9465there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9466means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9467in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9468doing the compilation.
9469
9470Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
9471range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9472the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9473safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9474the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9475emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9476target floating point formats are identical.
9477
9478The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9479use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
9480floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9481their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
9482
9483@defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9484The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9485machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9486array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9487quantity.
9488@end defmac
9489
9490@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9491Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}. If the target
9492floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
9493@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
9494@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
9495@end deftypefn
9496
9497@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9498Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
9499@end deftypefn
9500
9501@deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9502Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9503@end deftypefn
9504
9505@deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9506Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9507@var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9508@end deftypefn
9509
9510@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9511Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9512representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9513decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9514defined by the C language for both.
9515@end deftypefn
9516
9517@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9518Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
9519@end deftypefn
9520
9521@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9522Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9523@end deftypefn
9524
9525@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9526Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9527@end deftypefn
9528
9529@deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9530Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
9531@var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
9532variable).
9533
9534The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}. Only the
9535following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
9536@code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
9537
9538If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
9539target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
9540@code{abort}. Callers should check for this situation first, using
9541@code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}. @xref{Storage Layout}.
9542@end deftypefn
9543
9544@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9545Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9546@end deftypefn
9547
9548@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9549Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9550@end deftypefn
9551
9552@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{x})
9553Truncates the floating point value @var{x} to fit in @var{mode}. The
9554return value is still a full-size @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, but it has an
9555appropriate bit pattern to be output as a floating constant whose
9556precision accords with mode @var{mode}.
9557@end deftypefn
9558
9559@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9560Converts a floating point value @var{x} into a double-precision integer
9561which is then stored into @var{low} and @var{high}. If the value is not
9562integral, it is truncated.
9563@end deftypefn
9564
9565@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9566Converts a double-precision integer found in @var{low} and @var{high},
9567into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}. The
9568value is truncated to fit in mode @var{mode}.
9569@end deftypefn
9570
9571@node Mode Switching
9572@section Mode Switching Instructions
9573@cindex mode switching
9574The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9575
9576@defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9577Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9578switching in an optimizing compilation.
9579
9580For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9581floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9582the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9583operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
9584purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
9585be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
9586or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9587
9588You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9589which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
9590return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9591If you define this macro, you also have to define
9592@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
9593@code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
9594@code{MODE_AFTER}, @code{MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{MODE_EXIT}
9595are optional.
9596@end defmac
9597
9598@defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9599If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9600initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
9601N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9602of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
9603The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9604zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9605entity in question.
9606In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
9607represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
9608switch is needed / supplied.
9609@end defmac
9610
9611@defmac MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
9612@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
9613@code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
9614return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
9615@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
9616be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
9617@end defmac
9618
9619@defmac MODE_AFTER (@var{mode}, @var{insn})
9620If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during
9621mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if
9622different from the incoming mode).
9623@end defmac
9624
9625@defmac MODE_ENTRY (@var{entity})
9626If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9627mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9628@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{MODE_ENTRY}
9629is defined then @code{MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
9630@end defmac
9631
9632@defmac MODE_EXIT (@var{entity})
9633If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9634mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9635@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{MODE_EXIT}
9636is defined then @code{MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
9637@end defmac
9638
9639@defmac MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
9640This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
96410 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
9642lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
9643for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
9644(@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
9645@code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
9646@end defmac
9647
9648@defmac EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
9649Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
9650@var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
9651the insn(s) are to be inserted.
9652@end defmac
9653
9654@node Target Attributes
9655@section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
9656@cindex target attributes
9657@cindex machine attributes
9658@cindex attributes, target-specific
9659
9660Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
9661These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
9662be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
9663
9664@hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9665If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
9666attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
9667specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
9668entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
9669take.
9670@end deftypevr
9671
9672@hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P
9673If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
9674machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
9675given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
9676subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
9677false for all machine-specific attributes.
9678@end deftypefn
9679
9680@hook TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9681If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
9682@var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
9683and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
9684generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
9685supposed always to be compatible.
9686@end deftypefn
9687
9688@hook TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9689If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
9690the newly defined @var{type}.
9691@end deftypefn
9692
9693@hook TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9694Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
9695handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9696@code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
9697that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
9698function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
9699merging.
9700@end deftypefn
9701
9702@hook TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9703Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
9704handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9705@code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
9706@var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
9707when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
9708attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
9709call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
9710
9711@findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9712If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
9713for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
9714@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
9715will then define a function called
9716@code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
9717the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
9718add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
9719to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
9720@samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
9721@file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
9722@end deftypefn
9723
9724@hook TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P
9725
9726@defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
9727Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
9728@code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
9729default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
9730@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
9731of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
9732on this implementation detail.
9733@end defmac
9734
9735@hook TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES
9736Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
9737when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
9738wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
9739the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
9740created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
9741for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
9742shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
9743the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
9744attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
9745needed.
9746@end deftypefn
9747
9748@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P
9749@cindex inlining
9750This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
9751into the current function, despite its having target-specific
9752attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
9753target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
9754@end deftypefn
9755
9756@hook TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P
9757This hook is called to parse the @code{attribute(option("..."))}, and
9758it allows the function to set different target machine compile time
9759options for the current function that might be different than the
9760options specified on the command line. The hook should return
9761@code{true} if the options are valid.
9762
9763The hook should set the @var{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
9764the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target specific
9765@var{struct cl_target_option} structure.
9766@end deftypefn
9767
9768@hook TARGET_OPTION_SAVE
9769This hook is called to save any additional target specific information
9770in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for function specific
9771options.
9772@xref{Option file format}.
9773@end deftypefn
9774
9775@hook TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE
9776This hook is called to restore any additional target specific
9777information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9778function specific options.
9779@end deftypefn
9780
9781@hook TARGET_OPTION_PRINT
9782This hook is called to print any additional target specific
9783information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9784function specific options.
9785@end deftypefn
9786
56cb42ea 9787@hook TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE
38f8b050
JR
9788This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC option} to
9789set the machine specific options for functions that occur later in the
9790input stream. The options should be the same as handled by the
56cb42ea 9791@code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
38f8b050
JR
9792@end deftypefn
9793
9794@hook TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE
9795Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
9796a particular target machine. You can override the hook
9797@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
9798once just after all the command options have been parsed.
9799
9800Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
fac0f722 9801@option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
38f8b050
JR
9802
9803If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
9804changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
9805@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
9806@end deftypefn
9807
9808@hook TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P
9809This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
9810cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
9811default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
9812specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
9813@end deftypefn
9814
9815@node Emulated TLS
9816@section Emulating TLS
9817@cindex Emulated TLS
9818
9819For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
9820specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
9821used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
9822configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
9823the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
9824layer.
9825
9826The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
9827object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
9828which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
9829address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
9830
9831@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
9832Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
9833object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
9834emulated TLS helper function to be used.
9835@end deftypevr
9836
9837@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
9838Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
9839program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
9840initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
9841have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
9842registration function to be used.
9843@end deftypevr
9844
9845@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
9846Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
9847be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
9848any section.
9849@end deftypevr
9850
9851@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
9852Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
9853placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
9854section.
9855@end deftypevr
9856
9857@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
9858Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
9859The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9860@end deftypevr
9861
9862@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
9863Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
9864default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9865@end deftypevr
9866
9867@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS
9868Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
9869object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
9870@var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
9871@code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
9872for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
9873@end deftypefn
9874
9875@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT
9876Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
9877TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
9878is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
9879initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
9880@end deftypefn
9881
9882@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
9883Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
9884fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
9885single objects. The default is false.
9886@end deftypevr
9887
9888@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
9889Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
9890may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
9891@end deftypevr
9892
9893@node MIPS Coprocessors
9894@section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
9895@cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
9896
9897The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
9898coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
9899accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
9900and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
9901
9902@smallexample
9903 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
9904 unsigned int d;
9905
9906 d = cp0count + 3;
9907@end smallexample
9908
9909(``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
9910names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
9911overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
9912
9913Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
9914be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
9915later in the function.
9916
9917Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
9918the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
9919floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
9920
9921There is one macro used in defining the MIPS coprocessor interface which
9922you may want to override in subtargets; it is described below.
9923
9924@defmac ALL_COP_ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
9925A comma-separated list (with leading comma) of pairs describing the
9926alternate names of coprocessor registers. The format of each entry should be
9927@smallexample
9928@{ @var{alternatename}, @var{register_number}@}
9929@end smallexample
9930Default: empty.
9931@end defmac
9932
9933@node PCH Target
9934@section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
9935@cindex parameters, precompiled headers
9936
9937@hook TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY
9938This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
9939@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
9940@samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
9941@end deftypefn
9942
9943@hook TARGET_PCH_VALID_P
9944This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
9945compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
9946if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
9947be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
9948
9949@var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
9950when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
9951It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
9952compiler, so no format checking is needed.
9953
9954The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
9955suitable for most targets.
9956@end deftypefn
9957
9958@hook TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS
9959If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
9960@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
9961of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
9962@code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
9963value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
9964@end deftypefn
9965
9966@node C++ ABI
9967@section C++ ABI parameters
9968@cindex parameters, c++ abi
9969
9970@hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE
9971Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
9972These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
9973default is long_long_integer_type_node.
9974@end deftypefn
9975
9976@hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT
9977This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
9978@code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
9979@code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
9980@end deftypefn
9981
9982@hook TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE
9983This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
9984whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
9985known that a cookie is needed. The default is
9986@code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
9987IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
9988@end deftypefn
9989
9990@hook TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE
9991This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
9992array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
9993@end deftypefn
9994
9995@hook TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS
9996If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
9997class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
9998will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
9999to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
10000modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
10001backend's targeted operating system.
10002@end deftypefn
10003
10004@hook TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS
10005This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
10006the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
10007@code{false}.
10008@end deftypefn
10009
10010@hook TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE
10011This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
10012which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
10013table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
10014Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
10015the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
10016some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
10017method. The default is to return @code{true}.
10018@end deftypefn
10019
10020@hook TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY
10021
10022@hook TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT
10023This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10024similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10025external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
10026classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10027unit will not be COMDAT.
10028@end deftypefn
10029
10030@hook TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT
10031This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10032the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10033be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10034@end deftypefn
10035
10036@hook TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT
10037This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10038should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10039is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10040@end deftypefn
10041
10042@hook TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT
10043This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10044in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10045destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10046shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10047unloaded. The default is to return false.
10048@end deftypefn
10049
10050@hook TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION
10051
10052@node Named Address Spaces
10053@section Adding support for named address spaces
10054@cindex named address spaces
10055
10056The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10057standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10058support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10059processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10060GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10061address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10062spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10063@code{const} type attributes.
10064
10065Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10066pointers to the generic address space.
10067
10068For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10069to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10070processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10071issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10072local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10073address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10074@option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10075always 32 bits).
10076
10077Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10078range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10079address space.
10080
10081To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10082the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10083the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10084named address space #1:
10085@smallexample
10086#define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10087c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10088@end smallexample
10089
10090@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE
10091Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10092@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10093The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode} for the
10094generic address space only.
10095@end deftypefn
10096
10097@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE
10098Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10099@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10100The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode} for the
10101generic address space only.
10102@end deftypefn
10103
10104@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE
10105Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10106with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10107hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10108except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10109version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10110@code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10111target hooks for the given address space.
10112@end deftypefn
10113
10114@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
10115Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10116@var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10117parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10118finished. This target hook is the same as the
10119@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10120explicit named address space support.
10121@end deftypefn
10122
10123@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
10124Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10125with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10126hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10127except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10128@end deftypefn
10129
10130@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P
10131Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10132contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10133a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10134will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10135arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
10136converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10137@end deftypefn
10138
10139@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT
10140Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10141@var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10142space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10143to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10144guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10145as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10146@end deftypefn
10147
10148@node Misc
10149@section Miscellaneous Parameters
10150@cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10151
10152@c prevent bad page break with this line
10153Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10154
10155@defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10156Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10157has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10158conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10159blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10160set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10161to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10162@end defmac
10163
10164@defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10165Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10166has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10167conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10168blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10169set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10170to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10171@end defmac
10172
10173@defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10174An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10175elements of a jump-table should have.
10176@end defmac
10177
10178@defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10179Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10180when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10181it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10182To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10183make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10184The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10185flags can be updated.
10186@end defmac
10187
10188@defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10189Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10190should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10191jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10192contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10193is in effect.
10194@end defmac
10195
10196@hook TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
10197This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10198is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10199The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10200five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
10201@end deftypefn
10202
10203@defmac CASE_USE_BIT_TESTS
10204Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate whether C switch
10205statements may be implemented by a sequence of bit tests. This is
10206advantageous on processors that can efficiently implement left shift
10207of 1 by the number of bits held in a register, but inappropriate on
10208targets that would require a loop. By default, this macro returns
10209@code{true} if the target defines an @code{ashlsi3} pattern, and
10210@code{false} otherwise.
10211@end defmac
10212
10213@defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10214Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
10215smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10216Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10217@end defmac
10218
10219@defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
10220Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
10221memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10222bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
10223zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
10224of @var{mem_mode} for which the
10225insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
10226@code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
10227
10228This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
10229greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10230value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
10231@code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
10232define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
10233
10234You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
10235the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10236of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10237when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10238integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10239
10240You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
10241mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10242@code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10243is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
10244@end defmac
10245
10246@defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
10247Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10248extends.
10249@end defmac
10250
10251@defmac FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
10252Define this macro if the same instructions that convert a floating
10253point number to a signed fixed point number also convert validly to an
10254unsigned one.
10255@end defmac
10256
10257@hook TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL
10258When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10259divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10260the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10261that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10262of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10263has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10264@end deftypefn
10265
10266@defmac MOVE_MAX
10267The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10268between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
10269@end defmac
10270
10271@defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
10272The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10273between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10274is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10275constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10276at run-time.
10277@end defmac
10278
10279@defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
10280A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10281actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10282of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
10283this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
10284a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10285truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
10286instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
10287include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10288also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
10289arguments to bit-field instructions.
10290
10291If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
10292position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
10293instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10294
10295However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10296only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
10297bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
10298such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10299the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10300
10301You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
10302@end defmac
10303
10304@anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
10305@hook TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK
10306This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10307deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10308@xref{shift patterns}.
10309
10310On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10311shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10312equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10313this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10314otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10315particular behavior is guaranteed.
10316
10317Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10318@emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10319that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10320
10321The default implementation of this function returns
10322@code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10323and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10324@code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10325nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10326by overriding it.
10327@end deftypefn
10328
10329@defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
10330A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10331``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10332bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10333operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10334
10335On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10336
10337@c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10338@c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10339When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10340modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10341If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10342such cases may improve things.
10343@end defmac
10344
10345@hook TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED
10346The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
10347are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10348@code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10349sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10350otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10351representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10352@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10353@code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
10354@var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
10355widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10356
10357Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10358value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10359as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10360@code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10361
10362Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10363describe two related properties. If you define
10364@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10365to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10366extension.
10367
10368In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10369@code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10370@code{mode}.
10371@end deftypefn
10372
10373@defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
10374A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10375with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
10376(@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10377apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
10378comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10379
10380A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10381comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
10382and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10383which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10384true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10385operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
10386@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
10387@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10388the compiler.
10389
10390If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
10391generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10392replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10393the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10394For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10395@code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10396@samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10397expression
10398
10399@smallexample
10400(ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10401@end smallexample
10402
10403@noindent
10404can be converted to
10405
10406@smallexample
10407(ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10408@end smallexample
10409
10410@noindent
10411where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10412tested into the sign bit.
10413
10414There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10415for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10416but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
10417are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
10418perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
10419comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
10420
10421Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10422from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10423choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10424to be used:
10425
10426@itemize @bullet
10427@item
10428Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10429@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10430``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10431comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10432combine the normalization with other operations.
10433
10434@item
10435For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
10436slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10437other machines.
10438
10439@item
10440As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10441exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10442others.
10443
10444@item
10445Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10446@end itemize
10447
10448Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10449@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10450instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10451those cases, e.g., one matching
10452
10453@smallexample
10454(set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10455@end smallexample
10456
10457Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10458condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
10459@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
10460machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10461and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10462@code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
2b0d3573 10463@file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptimizer can be used to
38f8b050
JR
10464find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10465
10466If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10467not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10468instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
10469@end defmac
10470
10471@defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10472A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
10473returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
10474Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
10475floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10476this macro.
10477@end defmac
10478
10479@defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10480A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
10481for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10482mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10483this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10484return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10485this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10486@code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10487the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10488given mode.
10489@end defmac
10490
10491@defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10492@defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10493A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
ff2ce160 10494for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
38f8b050
JR
10495A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10496If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10497evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10498entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
ff2ce160 10499the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
38f8b050 10500In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
ff2ce160 10501this value.
38f8b050
JR
10502
10503If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10504@code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
10505
10506This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10507relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
10508is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10509to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
10510
10511Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10512and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10513visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10514to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
10515breaking the API@.
10516@end defmac
10517
10518@defmac Pmode
10519An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10520this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10521pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10522On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10523modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10524
10525The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10526@code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10527@code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10528to @code{Pmode}.
10529@end defmac
10530
10531@defmac FUNCTION_MODE
10532An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
10533being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
ff2ce160 10534where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
38f8b050
JR
10535@code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10536size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10537as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
10538@end defmac
10539
10540@defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
10541In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10542constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10543hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10544where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10545strict conformance to the C Standard.
10546
10547Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10548convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10549files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
10550@end defmac
10551
10552@defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
10553Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
10554This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10555C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10556@samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
10557@end defmac
10558
10559@findex #pragma
10560@findex pragma
10561@defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
10562Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
10563If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
10564@code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10565for each pragma. The macro may also do any
10566setup required for the pragmas.
10567
10568The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10569other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
10570definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
10571
10572If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
10573defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
10574
10575Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
10576@samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
10577silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
10578@end defmac
10579
10580@deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10581@deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10582
10583Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10584@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
10585@var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10586pragma of the form
10587
10588@smallexample
10589#pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10590@end smallexample
10591
10592@var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10593@code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
10594routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
10595on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
10596@var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
10597callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
10598a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
10599arguments of pragmas registered with
10600@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
10601pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
10602
10603Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
10604compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
10605other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
10606to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
10607building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
10608variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
10609target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
10610the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
10611code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
10612rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
10613how to build this object file.
10614@end deftypefun
10615
38f8b050 10616@defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
24a57808 10617Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
38f8b050
JR
10618arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
10619@end defmac
10620
10621@hook TARGET_HANDLE_PRAGMA_EXTERN_PREFIX
10622
10623@defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
10624If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
10625the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
10626This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
10627@samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
10628@end defmac
10629
10630@defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
10631Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
10632identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
10633not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
10634there is no need to define this macro in that case.
10635@end defmac
10636
10637@defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
10638Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10639@samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
10640G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
10641@samp{.} is used instead.
10642@end defmac
10643
10644@defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
10645Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10646@samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
10647have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
10648are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
10649@end defmac
10650
10651@defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10652Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10653delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10654even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
10655@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
10656every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
10657or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
10658you should define this macro.
10659
10660You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10661@end defmac
10662
10663@defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10664Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10665delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10666even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
10667@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
10668some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
10669are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
10670define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
10671instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
10672slot of @var{insn}.
10673
10674You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10675@end defmac
10676
10677@defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
10678Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
10679global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
10680symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
10681instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
10682from shared libraries (DLLs).
10683
10684You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
10685@end defmac
10686
10687@hook TARGET_MD_ASM_CLOBBERS
10688This target hook should add to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
10689any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for an asm.
10690It should return the result of the last @code{tree_cons} used to add a
10691clobber. The @var{outputs}, @var{inputs} and @var{clobber} lists are the
10692corresponding parameters to the asm and may be inspected to avoid
10693clobbering a register that is an input or output of the asm. You can use
10694@code{tree_overlaps_hard_reg_set}, declared in @file{tree.h}, to test
10695for overlap with regards to asm-declared registers.
10696@end deftypefn
10697
10698@defmac MATH_LIBRARY
10699Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
d9d16a19
JM
10700in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
10701@samp{""} if the target does not have a
38f8b050
JR
10702separate math library.
10703
d9d16a19 10704You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
38f8b050
JR
10705@end defmac
10706
10707@defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
10708Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
10709specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
10710
10711You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
10712is wrong.
10713@end defmac
10714
10715@defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
10716Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
10717functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
10718Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
10719to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
10720if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
10721for cross-profiling.
10722@end defmac
10723
10724@defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
10725
10726A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
10727conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
10728@code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
107291 if it does use cc0.
10730@end defmac
10731
10732@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10733Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
10734conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
10735@var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
10736contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
10737and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
10738then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
10739@var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
10740@end defmac
10741
10742@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10743Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
10744if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
10745@var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
10746being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
10747@end defmac
10748
10749@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
10750A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
10751be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
10752a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
10753about the currently processed blocks.
10754@end defmac
10755
10756@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
10757A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
10758converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10759can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10760to by @var{ce_info}.
10761@end defmac
10762
10763@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
10764A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
10765converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10766can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10767to by @var{ce_info}.
10768@end defmac
10769
10770@defmac IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS (@var{ce_info})
10771A C expression to initialize any extra fields in a @code{struct ce_if_block}
10772structure, which are defined by the @code{IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10773@end defmac
10774
10775@defmac IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS
10776If defined, it should expand to a set of field declarations that will be
10777added to the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure. These should be initialized
10778by the @code{IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10779@end defmac
10780
10781@hook TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
10782If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
10783instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
10784just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
10785
10786The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
10787it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
10788laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
10789Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
10790
10791You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
10792definition is null.
10793@end deftypefn
10794
10795@hook TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS
10796Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10797that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
10798necessary setup.
10799
10800Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
10801instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
10802they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
10803instructions or prefetch instructions).
10804
10805To create a built-in function, call the function
10806@code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
10807which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
1a072294 10808up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes};
38f8b050
JR
10809only language front ends that use those two functions will call
10810@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
10811@end deftypefn
10812
10813@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL
10814Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10815that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
10816builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
10817If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
10818if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
10819If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
10820@code{error_mark_node}.
10821@end deftypefn
10822
10823@hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN
10824
10825Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10826@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
10827function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
10828convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
10829@var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
10830@var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
10831ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
10832built-in function.
10833@end deftypefn
10834
d66f5459 10835@hook TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN
38f8b050
JR
10836Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
10837was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
10838@emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
10839implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
10840declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
10841arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
10842complete expression that implements the operation, usually
10843another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
10844@var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
10845@end deftypefn
10846
08914aaa 10847@hook TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN
38f8b050
JR
10848Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10849@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
10850built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
10851the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
10852The result is another tree containing a simplified expression for the
10853call's result. If @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
10854@end deftypefn
10855
10856@hook TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP
10857
10858Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
10859low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
10860could not be applied.
10861
10862Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
10863instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
10864the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
10865By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
10866loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
10867@end deftypefn
10868
10869@defmac MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH (@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
10870
10871Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
10872Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
10873@var{branch2} is possible.
10874
10875On some targets, branches may have a limited range. Optimizing the
10876filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
10877may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
10878@end defmac
10879
10880@hook TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P
10881This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
10882Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
10883PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
10884of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
10885@end deftypefn
10886
10887@hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE
10888
10889When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
10890register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
10891to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
10892it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
10893is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
10894that had its initial value copied by using
10895@code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
10896Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
10897to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
10898the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
10899@code{MEM}.
10900If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
10901it might decide to use another register anyways.
10902You may use @code{current_function_leaf_function} in the hook, functions
10903that use @code{REG_N_SETS}, to determine if the hard
10904register in question will not be clobbered.
10905The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
10906allocation.
10907@end deftypefn
10908
10909@hook TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P
10910This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
10911@code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
10912this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
10913@code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
10914to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
10915passed along.
10916@end deftypefn
10917
10918@hook TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION
ff2ce160 10919The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
38f8b050
JR
10920context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
10921the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
10922per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
10923attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
10924The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
10925and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
10926and is returning to processing at the top level.
10927The default hook function does nothing.
10928
10929GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
10930some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
10931situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
10932or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
10933@code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
10934outside of any function scope.
10935@end deftypefn
10936
10937@defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
10938Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
10939files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
10940use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
10941@end defmac
10942
10943@defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
10944Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
10945automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
10946do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
10947executable files.
10948@end defmac
10949
10950@defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
10951If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
10952specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
10953Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
10954object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
10955lists.
10956@end defmac
10957
10958@defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
10959Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
10960method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
10961must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
10962For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
10963the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
10964defined as this expression:
10965
10966@smallexample
10967build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
10968 build_tree_list
10969 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
10970 NULL))
10971@end smallexample
10972@end defmac
10973
10974@hook TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P
10975This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
10976instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
10977every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
10978reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
10979
10980@smallexample
10981static bool
10982cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
10983@{
10984 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
10985@}
10986@end smallexample
10987@end deftypefn
10988
10989@hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS
10990This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
10991optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
10992usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
10993re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
10994to inter-block scheduling.
10995@end deftypefn
10996
10997@hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED
10998Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
10999registers
11000that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
11001returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
11002that all target registers in the class returned by
11003@samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
11004saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
11005epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
11006true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
11007to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
11008to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
11009@end deftypefn
11010
11011@hook TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION
11012This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
11013This target hook is required only when the target has several different
11014modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
11015@end deftypefn
11016
11017@hook TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST
11018This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
11019should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11020the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11021the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11022is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11023number of memory accesses.
11024@end deftypefn
11025
11026@defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
11027If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
11028that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11029that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11030constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11031more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11032system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11033The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11034@end defmac
11035
11036@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11037This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11038target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
11039are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11040The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11041@end deftypefn
11042
11043@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11044This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11045target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11046indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11047@var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11048@var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11049@end deftypefn
11050
11051@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11052This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11053The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11054systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11055that are different from @option{-I}.
11056@end deftypefn
11057
11058@defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11059This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11060for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11061@code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11062functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11063@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11064@end defmac
11065
11066@defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11067If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11068target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11069option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11070@end defmac
11071
11072@defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11073If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11074@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11075@end defmac
11076
11077@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11078If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11079target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11080default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11081@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11082@end defmac
11083
11084@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11085If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11086@code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11087@end defmac
11088
11089@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11090If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11091routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11092and scanf formatter settings.
11093@end defmac
11094
11095@hook TARGET_RELAXED_ORDERING
11096If set to @code{true}, means that the target's memory model does not
11097guarantee that loads which do not depend on one another will access
11098main memory in the order of the instruction stream; if ordering is
11099important, an explicit memory barrier must be used. This is true of
11100many recent processors which implement a policy of ``relaxed,''
11101``weak,'' or ``release'' memory consistency, such as Alpha, PowerPC,
11102and ia64. The default is @code{false}.
11103@end deftypevr
11104
11105@hook TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN
11106If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11107illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11108with prototype @var{typelist}.
11109@end deftypefn
11110
11111@hook TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION
11112If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11113invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11114if validity should be determined by the front end.
11115@end deftypefn
11116
11117@hook TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP
11118If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11119invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11120@code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11121if validity should be determined by the front end.
11122@end deftypefn
11123
11124@hook TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP
11125If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11126invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11127and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11128the front end.
11129@end deftypefn
11130
11131@hook TARGET_INVALID_PARAMETER_TYPE
11132If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
ff2ce160 11133invalid for functions to include parameters of type @var{type},
38f8b050
JR
11134or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11135the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11136@end deftypefn
11137
11138@hook TARGET_INVALID_RETURN_TYPE
11139If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
ff2ce160 11140invalid for functions to have return type @var{type},
38f8b050
JR
11141or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11142the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11143@end deftypefn
11144
11145@hook TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE
ff2ce160
MS
11146If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11147@var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
38f8b050
JR
11148analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11149front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11150target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11151This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11152@end deftypefn
11153
11154@hook TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE
ff2ce160
MS
11155If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11156@var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
38f8b050 11157or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
ff2ce160 11158This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
38f8b050
JR
11159conversion rules.
11160This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11161@end deftypefn
11162
11163@defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
11164This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
11165classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
11166SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
11167@end defmac
11168
11169@defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11170This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11171NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11172@end defmac
11173
11174@defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11175Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
ff2ce160 11176to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
38f8b050
JR
11177call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11178and the associated definitions of those functions.
11179@end defmac
11180
11181@hook TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY
11182Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11183necessary.
11184@end deftypefn
11185
11186@hook TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX
11187This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
11188different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
11189argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11190is needed.
11191@end deftypefn
11192
11193@hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS
11194When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11195arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11196stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11197debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11198@code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11199cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11200to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11201false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11202@end deftypefn
11203
11204@hook TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11205On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11206a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11207is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11208is computed from this register using immediate addition or
11209subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
11210the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11211available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11212constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11213down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11214@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11215accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11216value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11217MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11218@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
11219is zero, which disables this optimization. @end deftypevr